IBM Ion M Pro Type 6868 Hardware Maintenance Manual
IBM Ion M Pro Type 6868 Hardware Maintenance Manual
IBM Ion M Pro Type 6868 Hardware Maintenance Manual
S00N-4019-02
PC 300 Series IntelliStation Aptiva (Type 2173/2178/2198) Volume 2: Hardware Maintenance Manual June, 2000 We Want Your Comments! (Please see page 441)
This Manual Supports: 300 Series, Type 6268 6278 6288 6338 6563 6564 6565 6574 IntelliStation, Type 6868 6878 Aptiva, Type 2173 2178 2198
S00N-4019-02
PC 300 Series IntelliStation Aptiva (Type 2173/2178/2198) Volume 2: Hardware Maintenance Manual June, 2000 We Want Your Comments! (Please see page 441)
IBM
Note Before using this information and the product it supports, be sure to read the general information under Notices on page 450. Third Edition (February 2000) The following paragraph does not apply to the United Kingdom or any country where such provisions are inconsistent with local law: INTERNATIONAL BUSINESS MACHINES CORPORATION PROVIDES THIS PUBLICATION AS IS WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Some states do not allow disclaimer of express or implied warranties in certain transactions, therefore, this statement may not apply to you. This publication could include technical inaccuracies or typographical errors. Changes are periodically made to the information herein; these changes will be incorporated in new editions of the publication. IBM may make improvements and/or changes in the product(s) and/or the program(s) described in this publication at any time. This publication was developed for products and services offered in the United States of America. IBM may not offer the products, services, or features discussed in this document in other countries, and the information is subject to change without notice. Consult your local IBM representative for information on the products, services, and features available in your area. Requests for technical information about IBM products should be made to your IBM reseller or IBM marketing representative. Copyright International Business Machines Corporation 1999, 2000. All rights reserved. Note to U.S. Government usersDocumentation related to Restricted rightsUse, duplication, or disclosure is subject to restrictions set forth in GSA ADP Schedule Contract with IBM Corp.
ii
iii
Prenez connaissance de toutes les consignes de type Attention et Danger avant de procder aux oprations dcrites par les instructions. Lesen Sie alle Sicherheitshinweise, bevor Sie eine Anweisung ausfhren. Accertarsi di leggere tutti gli avvisi di attenzione e di pericolo prima di effettuare qualsiasi operazione.
Lea atentamente todas las declaraciones de precaucin y peligro ante de llevar a cabo cualquier operacin.
iv
Related publications
The following publications are available for IBM products. For more information, contact IBM or an IBM Authorized Dealer.
For Information About PC300/700 and IntelliStation computers - Volume 1 HMM See Publication IBM Personal Computer Hardware Maintenance Manual Volume 1 (S83G-7789) IBM Personal Computer Hardware Maintenance Manual Volume 3 (S09N-8603) IBM Personal System/2 Hardware Maintenance Manual (S52G-9971) IBM PS/ValuePoint Hardware Maintenance Service and Reference (S61G-1423) IBM Mobile Systems Hardware Maintenance Manual Volume 1 (S82G-1501)
PS/2 Computers
PS/ValuePoint Computers
Laptop, Notebook, Portable, and ThinkPad Computers (L40, CL57, N45, N51, P70/P75, ThinkPad 300, 350, 500, 510, 710T, Expansion Unit, Dock I, Dock II) ThinkPad Computers (ThinkPad 340, 355, 360, 370, 700, 701, 720, 750, 755) ThinkPad Computers (ThinkPad 365, 560, 760, SelectaDock) Monitors (Displays) (February 1993) Monitors (December 1993) IBM Monitors (P/G Series) (June 1996) IBM 2248 Monitor (February 1996) Disk Array technology overview and using the IBM RAID Configuration Program Installation Planning for Personal System/2 computers Installation Planning for Advanced Personal System/2 Servers
IBM Mobile Systems Hardware Maintenance Manual Volume 2 (S82G-1502) IBM Mobile Systems Hardware Maintenance Manual Volume 3 (S82G-1503) IBM PS/2 Display HMM Volume 1 (SA38-0053) IBM Color Monitor HMM Volume 2 (S71G-4197) IBM Monitor HMM Volume 3 (S52H-3679) IBM Monitor HMM Volume 4 (S52H-3739) Configuring Your Disk Array booklet (S82G-1506) Personal System/2 Installation Planning and Beyond (G41G-2927) Advanced PS/2 Servers Planning and Selection Guide (GG24-3927)
vi
Contents
About this manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Important safety information . . . . . . . . . . Related publications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics error codes PC 300 - 6268/6278/6288/6338 Aptiva - 2173 General checkout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Diagnostics and test information . . . . . . . Product description . . . . . . . . . . . . . Additional service information . . . . . . . . Computer exploded view (Type 6268/6278/2173) Computer exploded view (Type 6288/6338) . . System board layout . . . . . . . . . . . . Symptom-to-FRU index . . . . . . . . . . . Undetermined problem . . . . . . . . . . . Model tables - Country/Region/Language . . . Parts (Type 6268/6278/2173) . . . . . . . . Parts (Type 6288/6338) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii iii v 1 21 24 32 43 47 61 70 77 80 102 103 114 117 121 124 132 143 146 160 167 176 179 201 202 219 222 227 233 236 244 255 257 272 279 282 304 305 314 319 322 330
PC 300 - 6563/6593/6564/6574 Aptiva - 2178/2198 General checkout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Diagnostics and test information . . . . . . . . . Product description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Additional service information . . . . . . . . . . Computer exploded view (Type 6563/6593) . . . . Computer exploded view (Type 6564/6574/2178/2198) . . . . . . . . . . . . . System board layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Symptom-to-FRU index . . . . . . . . . . . . . Undetermined problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . Model tables - Country/Region/Language . . . . . Parts (Type 6563, 6593) . . . . . . . . . . . . . Parts (Type 6564/6574) . . . . . . . . . . . . . Parts (Type 2178/2198) . . . . . . . . . . . . . PC 300 - 6565/6566 . . . . . . . . . . General checkout . . . . . . . . . . . . Diagnostics and test information . . . . . Product description . . . . . . . . . . . Additional service information . . . . . . Computer exploded view (Type 6565/6566) System board layout . . . . . . . . . . Symptom-to-FRU index . . . . . . . . . Undetermined problem . . . . . . . . . Model tables - Country/Region/Language . Parts (Type 6565/6566) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
IntelliStation - 6868/6878 . . . . . . . . . . . . General checkout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Diagnostics and test information . . . . . . . . . Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2000
vii
Product description . . . . . . . . . . . Additional service information . . . . . . Computer exploded view (Type 6868/6878) System board layout . . . . . . . . . . Symptom-to-FRU index . . . . . . . . . Undetermined problem . . . . . . . . . Model tables - Country/Region/Language . Parts (Type 6868/6878) . . . . . . . . . Related Service Information . . . . Safety notices (multi-lingual translations) Safety information . . . . . . . . . . Miscellaneous information . . . . . . Send us your comments! . . . . . . Do you need technical references? . . Problem determination tips . . . . . Notices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
341 343 360 367 370 392 393 403 409 410 434 439 441 442 443 450
viii
1. Flash the system 2. System board 1. Flash the system 2. Boot block 3. System board 1. Flash the system 2. Adapter card 3. System board 1. Flash the system 2. System board 1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file.
FRU/Action 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to the Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test. 3. Replace component under function test. 1. Flash the system 2. System board 1. Flash the system 2. System board 1. No action 1. System board 1. System board 1. System board
000-250-XXX BIOS APM failure 000-270-XXX BIOS ACPI failure 001-000-XXX System Test Passed 001-00X-XXX System Error 001-01X-XXX System Error 001-024-XXX System Addressing test failure 001-025-XXX System Checksum Value error 001-026-XXX System FLASH data error 001-027-XXX System Configuration/Setup error 001-032-XXX System Device Controller failure 001-034-XXX System Device Buffer Allocation failure
1. Flash the system 2. System board 1. Flash the system 2. System board 1. Run Setup 2. Flash the system 3. System board 1. System board
1. 2. 3. 4.
Reboot the system Flash the system Run memory test System board
Diagnostic Error Code 001-035-XXX System Device Reset condition detected 001-036-XXX System Register error 001-038-XXX System Extension failure 001-039-XXX System DMI data structure error 001-040-XXX System IRQ failure 001-041-XXX System DMA failure 001-195-XXX System Test aborted by user 001-196-XXX System test halt, error threshold exceeded 001-197-XXX System test warning
1. System board 1. Adapter card 2. System board 1. Flash the system 2. System board 1. Power-off/on system and re-test 2. System board 1. Power-off/on system and re-test 2. System board 1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file. 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. System board 1. System board
001-250-XXX System ECC error 001-254-XXX 001-255-XXX 001-256-XXX 001-257-XXX System DMA error
Diagnostic Error Code 001-260-XXX 001-264-XXX System IRQ error 001-268-XXX System IRQ1 failure 001-269-XXX System IRQ2 failure 001-270-XXX System IRQ3 failure 001-271-XXX System IRQ4 failure 001-272-XXX System IRQ5 failure 001-273-XXX System IRQ6 (diskette drive) failure 001-274-XXX System IRQ7 failure 001-275-XXX System IRQ8 failure 001-276-XXX System IRQ9 failure 001-277-XXX System IRQ10 failure 001-278-XXX System IRQ11 failure 001-279-XXX System IRQ12 failure 001-280-XXX System IRQ13 failure 001-281-XXX System IRQ14 (hard disk drive) failure 001-282-XXX System IRQ15 failure 001-286-XXX 001-287-XXX 001-288-XXX System Timer failure 001-292-XXX System CMOS RAM error 001-293-XXX System CMOS Battery 001-298-XXX System RTC date/time update failure 001-299-XXX System RTC periodic interrupt failure
1. device on IRQ1 2. System board 1. device on IRQ2 2. System board 1. device on IRQ3 2. System board 1. device on IRQ4 2. System board 1. device on IRQ5 2. System board 1. Diskette Cable 2. Diskette drive 3. System board 1. device on IRQ7 2. System board 1. device on IRQ8 2. System board 1. device on IRQ9 2. System board 1. device on IRQ10 2. System board 1. device on IRQ11 2. System board 1. device on IRQ12 2. System board 1. device on IRQ13 2. System board 1. Hard disk drive Cable 2. Hard disk drive 3. System board 1. device on IRQ15 2. System board 1. System board
1. Run Setup and re-test 2. System board 1. Battery 2. System board 1. Flash the system 2. System board 1. System board
Diagnostic Error Code 001-300-XXX System RTC Alarm failure 001-301-XXX System RTC Century byte error 005-000-XXX Video Test Passed 005-00X-XXX Video error 005-010-XXX 005-011-XXX 005-012-XXX 005-013-XXX Video Signal failure 005-016-XXX Video Simple Pattern test failure 005-024-XXX Video Addressing test failure 005-025-XXX Video Checksum Value error 005-027-XXX Video Configuration/Setup error 005-031-XXX Video Device Cable failure
FRU/Action 1. System board 1. Flash the system 2. System board 1. No action 1. Video card, if installed 2. System board 1. Video card, if installed 2. System board
1. Video Ram 2. Video card, if installed 3. System board 1. Video card, if installed 2. System board 1. Video card, if installed 2. System board 1. 2. 3. 4. 1. 2. 3. 4. Run Setup Video drivers update Video card, if installed System board Video cable Monitor Video card, if installed System board
005-032-XXX Video Device Controller failure 005-036-XXX Video Register error 005-038-XXX System BIOS extension failure 005-040-XXX Video IRQ failure 005-195-XXX Video Test aborted by user 005-196-XXX Video test halt, error threshold exceeded
1. Video card, if installed 2. System board 1. Video card, if installed 2. System board 1. Video card, if installed 2. System board 1. Video card, if installed 2. System board 1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file.
FRU/Action 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. Video card, if installed 2. System board 1. No action
005-2XX-XXX 005-3XX-XXX Video subsystem error 006-000-XXX Diskette interface Test Passed 006-0XX-XXX Diskette interface error 006-195-XXX Diskette interface Test aborted by user 006-196-XXX Diskette interface test halt, error threshold exceeded 006-197-XXX Diskette interface test warning
1. Diskette drive Cable 2. Diskette drive 3. System board 1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file. 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test
FRU/Action 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. Diskette drive Cable 2. Diskette drive 3. System board 1. No action
006-25X-XXX Diskette interface Error 011-000-XXX Serial port Interface Test Passed 011-001-XXX Serial port Presence
1. Remove external serial device, if present 2. Run setup, enable port 3. System board 1. System board
011-002-XXX 011-003-XXX Serial port Timeout/Parity error 011-013-XXX 011-014-XXX Serial port Control Signal/Loopback test failure 011-015-XXX Serial port External Loopback failure 011-027-XXX Serial port Configuration/Setup error 011-03X-XXX 011-04X-XXX Serial port failure 011-195-XXX Serial port Test aborted by user 011-196-XXX Serial port test halt, error threshold exceeded
1. System board
1. Wrap plug 2. System board 1. Run Setup, enable port 2. Flash the system 3. System board 1. System board
1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file.
FRU/Action 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. External serial device 2. System board 1. No action
011-2XX-XXX Serial port signal failure 014-000-XXX Parallel port Interface Test Passed 014-001-XXX Parallel port Presence
1. Remove external parallel device, if present 2. Run setup, enable port 3. System board 1. System board
014-002-XXX 014-003-XXX Parallel port Timeout/Parity error 014-013-XXX 014-014-XXX Parallel port Control Signal/Loopback test failure 014-015-XXX Parallel port External Loopback failure 014-027-XXX Parallel port Configuration/Setup error 014-03X-XXX 014-04X-XXX Parallel port failure 014-195-XXX Parallel port Test aborted by user
1. System board
1. Wrap plug 2. System board 1. Run Setup, enable port 2. Flash the system 3. System board 1. System board
Diagnostic Error Code 014-196-XXX Parallel port test halt, error threshold exceeded 014-197-XXX Parallel port test warning
FRU/Action 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file. 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. External parallel device 2. System board 1. No action
014-2XX-XXX 014-3XX-XXX Parallel port failure 015-000-XXX USB port Interface Test Passed 015-001-XXX USB port Presence 015-002-XXX USB port Timeout 015-015-XXX USB port External Loopback failure 015-027-XXX USB port Configuration/Setup error 015-032-XXX USB port Device Controller failure 015-034-XXX USB port buffer allocation failure
1. Remove USB Device(s) and re-test 2. System board 1. Remove USB Device(s) and re-test 2. System board 1. Remove USB Device(s) and re-test 2. System board 1. Flash the system 2. System board 1. System board
1. 2. 3. 4.
Reboot the system Flash the system Run memory test System board
Diagnostic Error Code 015-035-XXX USB port Reset condition detected 015-036-XXX USB port Register error 015-040-XXX USB port IRQ failure
FRU/Action 1. Remove USB Device(s) and re-test 2. System board 1. System board 1. Run setup and check for conflicts 2. Flash the system 3. System board 1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file. 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. No action 1. PCI card 2. Riser card, if installed 3. System board 1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file.
015-195-XXX USB port Test aborted by user 015-196-XXX USB port test halt, error threshold exceeded 015-197-XXX USB port test warning
018-000-XXX PCI Card Test Passed 018-0XX-XXX PCI Card Failure 018-195-XXX PCI Card Test aborted by user 018-196-XXX PCI Card test halt, error threshold exceeded
10
FRU/Action 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. PCI card 2. Riser card, if installed 3. System board 1. No action 1. PCI card 2. Riser card, if installed 3. System board 1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file. 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section.
018-250-XXX PCI Card Services error 020-000-XXX PCI Interface Test Passed 020-0XX-XXX PCI Interface error 020-195-XXX PCI Test aborted by user 020-196-XXX PCI test halt, error threshold exceeded 020-197-XXX PCI test warning
11
FRU/Action 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. PCI card 2. Riser card, if installed 3. System board 1. No action 1. 2. 3. 4. 1. 2. 3. 4. 1. 2. 3. 4. IDE signal cable Check power supply IDE device System board IDE signal cable Flash the system IDE device System board IDE signal cable Check power supply IDE device System board
020-262-XXX PCI system error 025-000-XXX IDE interface Test Passed 025-00X-XXX 025-01X-XXX IDE interface failure 025-027-XXX IDE interface Configuration/Setup error 025-02X-XXX 025-03X-XXX 025-04X-XXX IDE Interface failure 025-195-XXX IDE interface Test aborted by user 025-196-XXX IDE interface test halt, error threshold exceeded 025-197-XXX IDE interface test warning
1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file. 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test.
12
Diagnostic Error Code 030-000-XXX SCSI interface Test Passed 030-00X-XXX 030-01X-XXX SCSI interface failure
FRU/Action 1. No action 1. 2. 3. 4. SCSI signal cable Check power supply SCSI device SCSI adapter card, if installed 5. System board 1. 2. 3. 4. SCSI signal cable Flash the system SCSI device SCSI adapter card, if installed 5. System board 1. 2. 3. 4. SCSI signal cable Check power supply SCSI device SCSI adapter card, if installed 5. System board 1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file. 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. No action
030-195-XXX SCSI interface Test aborted by user 030-196-XXX SCSI interface test halt, error threshold exceeded 030-197-XXX SCSI interface test warning
13
FRU/Action 1. RAID signal cable 2. RAID device 3. RAID adapter card, if installed 4. System board 1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file. 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. No action
035-195-XXX RAID interface Test aborted by user 035-196-XXX RAID interface test halt, error threshold exceeded 035-197-XXX RAID interface test warning
071-000-XXX Audio port Interface Test Passed 071-00X-XXX 071-01X-XXX 071-02X-XXX Audio port error 071-03X-XXX Audio port failure
1. Run Setup 2. Flash the system 3. System board 1. 2. 3. 4. Speakers Microphone Audio card, if installed System board
071-04X-XXX Audio port failure 071-195-XXX Audio port Test aborted by user
1. Run Setup 2. Audio card, if installed 3. System board 1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to
14
Diagnostic Error Code 071-196-XXX Audio port test halt, error threshold exceeded 071-197-XXX Audio port test warning
FRU/Action 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file. 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. Speakers 2. Audio card, if installed 3. System board 1. No action
071-25X-XXX Audio port failure 080-000-XXX Game Port interface Test Passed 080-XXX-XXX Game Port interface Error 080-195-XXX Game Port interface Test aborted by user 080-196-XXX Game Port interface test halt, error threshold exceeded 080-197-XXX Game Port interface test warning
1. Remove the game port device and re-test the system 1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file. 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test
15
FRU/Action 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. No action
086-000-XXX Mouse Port interface Test Passed 086-001-XXX Mouse Port interface Presence 086-032-XXX Mouse Port interface Device controller failure 086-035-XXX Mouse Port interface Reset 086-040-XXX Mouse Port interface IRQ failure 086-195-XXX Mouse Port interface Test aborted by user 086-196-XXX Mouse Port interface test halt, error threshold exceeded 086-197-XXX Mouse Port interface test warning
1. Mouse 2. System board 1. Mouse 2. System board 1. Mouse 2. System board 1. Run Setup 2. Mouse 3. System board 1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file. 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section.
16
Diagnostic Error Code 086-199-XXX Mouse Port interface test failed, cause unknown
FRU/Action 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. No action 1. Microprocessor(s) 2. System board 1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file. 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. No action
089-000-XXX Microprocessor Test Passed 089-XXX-XXX Microprocessor failure 089-195-XXX Microprocessor Test aborted by user 089-196-XXX Microprocessor test halt, error threshold exceeded 089-197-XXX Microprocessor test warning
170-000-XXX Voltage Sensor(s) Test Passed 170-0XX-XXX Voltage Sensor(s) failure 170-195-XXX Voltage Sensor(s) Test aborted by user 170-196-XXX Voltage Sensor(s) test halt, error threshold exceeded
1. Flash system 2. System board 1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file.
17
FRU/Action 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. Power supply 2. System board
170-250-XXX 170-251-XXX Voltage Sensor(s) Voltage limit error 170-254-XXX Voltage Sensor(s) Voltage Regulator Module error 175-000-XXX Thermal Sensor(s) Test Passed 175-0XX-XXX Thermal Sensor(s) failure 175-195-XXX Thermal Sensor(s) Test aborted by user 175-196-XXX Thermal Sensor(s) test halt, error threshold exceeded 175-197-XXX Thermal Sensor(s) test warning
1. Flash system 2. System board 1. Information 2. Re-start the test, if need to 1. Depress F3 to review the log file. 2. Re-start the test to reset the log file. 1. Make sure component that is called out is enabled and/or connected 2. Re-run test 3. Component that is called out in warning statement 4. Component under test
18
FRU/Action 1. If a component is called out, make sure it is enabled and/or connected 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Go to Undetermined problem section. 1. Go to Undetermined problem section. 2. Flash the system and re-test 3. Replace component under function test. 1. 2. 3. 4. Check fans Check Power supply Microprocessor System board
175-250-XXX 175-251-XXX Thermal Sensor(s) limit error 185-000-XXX Asset Security Test Passed 185-XXX-XXX Asset Security failure
1. No action 1. Assure Asset Security Enabled 2. Flash system 3. System board 1. C2 Cover Switch 2. System board 1. No action
185-278-XXX Asset Security Chassis Intrusion 201-000-XXX System Memory Test Passed 201-XXX-XXX System Memory error
1. Replace the memory module called out by the test 2. System board 1. No action 1. Cache, if removable 2. System board 3. Microprocessor 1. No action 1. Diskette Drive Cable 2. Check power supply voltages 3. Diskette drive 4. System board 1. No action 1. CD-ROM Drive Cable 2. Check power supply voltages 3. CD-ROM drive 4. System board
202-000-XXX System Cache Test Passed 202-XXX-XXX System Cache error 206-000-XXX Diskette Drive Test Passed 206-XXX-XXX Diskette Drive error
19
Diagnostic Error Code 217-000-XXX Hard Disk Drive Test Passed 217-25X-XXX 217-26X-XXX Hard Disk Drive (IDE) error
FRU/Action 1. No action
1. Hard Disk Drive Cable 2. Check power supply voltages 3. Hard Disk drive (IDE) 4. System board 1. Hard Disk Drive Cable 2. Check power supply voltages 3. Hard Disk drive (SCSI) 4. SCSI adapter card 5. System board 1. No action
220-000-XXX Hi-Capacity Cartridge Drive Test Passed 220-XXX-XXX Hi-Capacity Cartridge Drive error 301-000-XXX Keyboard Test Passed 301-XXX-XXX Keyboard error 302-000-XXX Mouse Test Passed 302-XXX-XXX Mouse error
1. Remove the Hi-Capacity Cartridge Drive and re-test the system 1. No action 1. Keyboard 2. Check and test Mouse 3. System board 1. No action 1. Mouse 2. Check and test Keyboard 3. System board 1. No action 1. Remove the Joystick and re-test the system 1. No action 1. Run Setup to enable DDC 2. Cable 3. Monitor 4. Video card 5. System board 1. No action 1. Remove the Modem and re-test the system
303-000-XXX Joystick Test Passed 303-XXX-XXX Joystick error 305-000-XXX Monitor DDC Test Passed 305-250-XXX Monitor DDC self test failure
20
21
SIMM/DIMM memory errors . . . . . . . . . Setup Utility program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hard disk drive boot error . . . . . . . . . . . When to use the Low-Level Format program . . Preparing the hard disk drive for use . . . . . . Product description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Specifications Type 6268/6278/2173 . . . . . . Specifications Type 6288/6338 . . . . . . . . . Additional service information . . . . . . . . . . . Replacing a processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacing a system board . . . . . . . . . . . Security features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Passwords . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power-on password . . . . . . . . . . . . . Administrator password . . . . . . . . . . . Administrator password control . . . . . . . Operating system password . . . . . . . . . Vital product data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Management Information Format (MIF) . . . . . Alert on LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hard disk drive jumper settings . . . . . . . . . IDE hard disk drive settings . . . . . . . . . CD-ROM drive jumper settings . . . . . . . . . BIOS levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flash (BIOS/VPD) update procedure . . . . . . Flash recovery boot block jumper . . . . . . . . Power management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Automatic configuration and power interface (ACPI) BIOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Advanced Power Management . . . . . . . Automatic Hardware Power Management features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting Automatic Hardware Power Management features . . . . . . . . . . . Automatic Power-On features . . . . . . . . Network settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flash over LAN (update POST/BIOS over network) Wake on LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System board memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . Computer exploded view (Type 6268/6278/2173) . . Input/Output connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . Cover removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front bezel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EMC shield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CD-ROM drive removal . . . . . . . . . . . . Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ZIP drive removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hard drive removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . HD/fan/speaker bracket removal . . . . . . . . Power supply removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . Computer exploded view (Type 6288/6338) . . . . . Input/Output connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . Cover removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
39 41 41 42 42 43 45 46 47 47 48 48 48 49 50 50 50 50 50 51 52 52 53 54 55 55 56 56 56 56 57 57 58 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 64 65 66 67 67 68 69 70 71 72 73
22
Front bezel . . . . . . . . . . . . EMC shield . . . . . . . . . . . . Diskette/hard drive bracket . . . . . CD-ROM drive removal . . . . . . Power supply removal . . . . . . . System board layout . . . . . . . . . System board locations . . . . . . System board jumper settings . . . Symptom-to-FRU index . . . . . . . . Beep symptoms . . . . . . . . . . No beep symptoms . . . . . . . . POST error codes . . . . . . . . . Miscellaneous error messages . . . Undetermined problem . . . . . . . . Model tables - Country/Region/Language Type/Model configuration tables (6268/6278/6288/6338) . . . . . . Parts (Type 6268/6278/2173) . . . . . Parts listing . . . . . . . . . . . . Parts (Type 6288/6338) . . . . . . . . Parts listing . . . . . . . . . . . . Special tools . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . .
23
General checkout
This general checkout procedure is for Type 6268/6278/6288/6338/2173 computers. Attention The drives in the computer you are servicing might have been rearranged or the drive startup sequence changed. Be extremely careful during write operations such as copying, saving, or formatting. Data or programs can be overwritten if you select an incorrect drive. Diagnostic error messages appear when a test program finds a problem with a hardware option. For the test programs to properly determine if a test Passed, Failed, or Aborted, the test programs check the error-return code at test completion. See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics on page 34. General error messages appear if a problem or conflict is found by an application program, the operating system, or both. For an explanation of these messages, refer to the information supplied with that software package. Notes 1. Before replacing any FRUs, ensure the latest level of BIOS is installed on the system. A down-level BIOS might cause false errors and unnecessary replacement of the system board. For more information on how to determine and obtain the latest level BIOS, see BIOS levels on page 54. 2. If multiple error codes are displayed, diagnose the first error code displayed. 3. If the computer hangs with a POST error, go to Symptom-to-FRU index on page 80. 4. If the computer hangs and no error is displayed, go to Undetermined problem on page 102. 5. If an installed device is not recognized by the diagnostics program, that device might be defective. The power-on default is quick bring-up. To enable Enhanced bring-up, select the Start Options in the Configuration/Setup Utility program (see Setup Utility program on page 41) then, enable Power On Status. 001 Power-off the computer and all external devices. Check all cables and power cords. Make sure the system board is seated properly. Set all display controls to the middle position. (Step 001 continues)
24
001 (continued) Insert the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics diskette into drive A. Power-on all external devices. Power-on the computer. Check for the following response: 1. Readable instructions or the Main Menu. Note Type 6268/6278/6288/6338/2173 computers default to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 41. DID YOU RECEIVE THE CORRECT RESPONSE? Yes No 002 If the Power Management feature is enabled, do the following: 1. Start the Configuration/Setup Utility program (see Setup Utility program on page 41) 2. Select Power Management from the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 3. Select APM 4. Be sure APM BIOS Mode is set to Disabled. If it is not, press Left Arrow ( ) or Right Arrow ( ) to change the setting. 5. Select Automatic Hardware Power Management. 6. Set Automatic Hardware Power Management to Disabled. or Go to the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics on page 34. 003 Run the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics test. If necessary, refer to Diagnostics and test information on page 32. If you receive an error, replace the part that the diagnostic program calls out or go to IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics on page 34. If the test stops and you cannot continue, replace the last device tested. If the computer has incorrect keyboard responses, go to Keyboard on page 28. (Step 003 continues)
25
(CONTINUED)
003 (continued) If the printer has incorrect responses, go to Printer on page 28. If the display has problems such as jittering, rolling, shifting, or being out of focus, go to Display on page 31.
26
27
Keyboard
Note If a mouse or other pointing device is attached, remove it to see if the error symptom goes away. If the symptom goes away, the mouse or pointing device is defective. 001 Power-off the computer. Disconnect the keyboard cable from the system unit. Power-on the computer and check the keyboard cable connector on the system unit for the voltages shown. All voltages are 5%.
Pin 1 2 3 4
5
6
6 4 2
5 3 1
ARE THE VOLTAGES CORRECT? Yes No 002 Replace the system board. 003 On keyboards with a detachable cable, replace the cable. If the problem remains or if the cable is permanently attached to the keyboard, replace the keyboard. If the problem remains, replace the system board.
Printer
1. Make sure the printer is properly connected and powered on. 2. Run the printer self-test. If the printer self-test does not run correctly, the problem is in the printer. Refer to the printer service manual. If the printer self-test runs correctly, install a wrap plug in the parallel port and run the diagnostic tests to determine which FRU failed. If the diagnostic tests (with the wrap plug installed) do not detect a failure, replace the printer cable. If that does not correct the problem, replace the system board or adapter connected to the printer cable.
28
Power supply
If the power-on indicator is not on, the power-supply fan is not running, or the computer will not power-off, do the following.
Check/Verify 1. Verify that the voltage-selector switch is set for the correct voltage. 2. Check the following for proper installation. Power Cord On/Off Switch connector On/Off Switch Power Supply connector System Board Power Supply connectors microprocessor(s) connection 3. Check the power cord for proper continuity. 4. Check the power-on switch for continuity. FRU/Action Correct the voltage-selector switch setting. Reseat
29
11
20
Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
Signal 3.3 V 3.3 V COM 5V COM 5V COM POK 5VSB 12 V 3.3 V -12 V COM PS-ON COM COM COM not used 5V 5V
Function +3.3 V dc +3.3 V dc Ground +5 V dc Ground +5 V dc Ground Power Good Standby Voltage +12 V dc +3.3 V dc -12 V dc Ground DC Remote Enable Ground Ground Ground not used +5 V dc +5 V dc
If the voltages are not correct, and the power cord is good, replace the power supply.
30
Display
If the screen is rolling, replace the display assembly. If that does not correct the problem, replace the video adapter (if installed) or replace the system board. If the screen is not rolling, do the following to run the display self-test: 1. 2. 3. 4. Power-off the computer and display. Disconnect the display signal cable. Power-on the display. Turn the brightness and contrast controls clockwise to their maximum setting. 5. Check for the following conditions: You should be able to vary the screen intensity by adjusting the contrast and brightness controls. The screen should be white or light gray, with a black margin (test margin) on the screen. Note The location of the test margin varies with the type of display. The test margin might be on the top, bottom, or one or both sides. If you do not see any test margin on the screen, replace the display. If there is a test margin on the screen, replace the video adapter (if installed) or replace the system board. Note During the first two or three seconds after the display is powered on, the following might occur while the display synchronizes with the computer. Unusual patterns or characters Static, crackling, or clicking sounds A power-on hum on larger displays A noticeable odor might occur on new displays or displays recently removed from storage. These sounds, display patterns, and odors are normal; do not replace any parts. If you are unable to correct the problem, go to Undetermined problem on page 102.
31
32
Note Type 6268/6278/6288/6338/2173 computers default to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: 1. Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 41.
RDDDPLSCB QEET Test state Error code Extension Qualifier Bus ( =internal 1=external) Capacity of the device Slot number of the device LUN (usually ) PUN (SCSI ID #) Device Number Reserved Digit (usually )
33
This diagnostic diskette includes: A new user interface (WaterGate Software's PC-Doctor) This interface serves as the control program for running both the IBM PC Enhanced Memory Diagnostics and the suite of diagnostic tests provided by PC-Doctor. IBM PC Enhanced Memory Diagnostics The memory diagnostic tests determine which memory module (SIMM or DIMM) is defective and report the socket where the failing module is located. The Memory diagnostics can run a quick and full test of the system. Diagnostics can also be run on a single SIMM or DIMM. Note See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnosticsfor the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics error codes.
34
Use the cursor movement keys to navigate within the menus. The Enter key is used to select a menu item. The Esc key is used to back up to the previous menu. For online help select F1.
Test selection
To select one or more tests: 1. Open the corresponding test category. 2. Using the cursor movement keys, highlight the desired test. 3. Press Space bar. A selected test is marked with a chevron, >>. Pressing the space bar again de-selects a test and removes the chevron. 4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 above to select all desired tests.
35
1. Select the DIAGNOSTICS option on the toolbar and press Enter. 2. Highlight either the 'Memory Test-Full' or 'Memory Test-Quick option and press Enter. Memory Test-Full The full memory test will take about 80 seconds per MB of memory and will detect marginal, intermittent, and solid (stuck) memory failures. Memory Test-Quick The quick memory test will take about 20 seconds per MB of memory and will detect solid (stuck) memory failures only. Notes Either level of memory testing can be performed on all memory or a single SIMM/DIMM socket. Only sockets containing a SIMM or DIMM can be selected for testing. Unpopulated sockets are noted by ........ besides the test description.
Asset ID test
The Asset ID test does the following: Determines if Asset ID is supported on the system. Verifies the EEPROM areas. Performs an antenna detection test.
Test results
IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostic test results will produce this error code format:
Function Failure Code Type DeviceID Date ChkDigits Text
Represents the feature or function within the PC. Represents the type of error encountered. Contains the component's unit-id which corresponds to either a fixed disk drive, removable media drive, serial or parallel port, processor, specific DIMM, or a device on the PCI bus.
36
Date:
ChkDigits:
Text: Note
Contains the date on which the diagnostic test was run. Date is retrieved from CMOS and displayed using the YYYYMMDD format. Contains a 2-digit check-digit value to ensure that: Diagnostics were run on the specified date Diagnostics were run on the specified IBM computer The diagnostic error code is recorded correctly Description of the error.
See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics error codes on page 1 for error code listings.
37
38
SIMM/DIMM memory errors: SIMM/DIMM error messages issued by the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics:
Message 2xx-1y Failure Found A memory error was detected in SIMM socket Y Recommended Actions Replace the SIMM in the socket identified by the last digit of the error code. Re-run the test. If the same error code occurs again, replace the system board. 2xx-2y A memory error was detected in DIMM socket Y Replace the DIMM in the socket identified by the last digit of the error code. Re-run the test. If the same error code occurs again, replace the system board or where memory is on the processor card, replace the processor card. Corrupt BIOS Information in BIOS is not as expected. Not able to find expected DMI information from BIOS. Memory controller chipset vendor ID does not match expected value. Reflash the BIOS. Perform boot block recovery. Replace the system board.
39
"Y" is the SIMM/DIMM socket number. Use the System Board Layouts section in the latest PC 300/700, IntelliStation Hardware Maintenance Manual, HMM, to reference the memory sockets.
40
41
Actions The drive must be formatted, do the following: 1. Attempt to access and recover (back-up) the failing hard disk drive. 2. Using the operating systems programs, format the hard disk drive. 3. Go to Preparing the hard disk drive for use on page 42.
42
Product description
The PC 300 Type 6268/6278/6288/6338 computers are available in 4 x 4, (Four drive bays, four I/O adapter slots) as desktop and micro-tower models. The IBM Aptiva Type 2173 computer is available in 4 x 4 micro-tower models only. Note Service information is the same for types 6268, 6278, 6288, 6338, and 2173 computers, unless specifically identified as type 6288/6338 which is the desktop computer. Type 6268 and 6278 are the micro-tower Type 6288/6338 is the desktop Type 2173 is the micro-tower Security Administrator password Cover lock Power-on password Operating system password U-bolt and cable (Optional for some models)
CMOS backup battery (lithium) Common parts (Varies with each model, see Type/Model configuration tables (6268/6278/6288/6338) on page 104.) Diskette drive Hard disk drive Keyboard Power supply Mouse
43
Specifications Information (ISO/ANSI) The model specifications information on the following pages was determined in controlled acoustical environments according to procedures specified by the American National Standards Institute (ANSI) S12.10 and ISO 7779, and are reported in accordance with ISO 9296. Actual sound pressure levels in your location might differ from the average values stated because of room reflections and other nearby noise sources. The declared sound power levels indicate an upper limit, below which a large proportion of machines will operate.
44
Weight Environment
Heat Output
Electrical Input
Maximum configuration weight depends on options installed. Figures above are a system fully populated with options. 2 Maximum power and heat specifications are based on the 145-watt maximum capacity of the system power supply. 3 For additional information, see the ISO Supplier's Declaration available from IBM.
45
Weight Environment
Heat Output
Electrical Input
Maximum configuration weight depends on options installed. Figures above are a system fully populated with options. 5 Maximum power and heat specifications are based on the 145-watt maximum capacity of the system power supply. 6 For additional information, see the ISO Supplier's Declaration available from IBM.
46
Replacing a processor
For Celeron processors, install the processor with the beveled corner aligned with the beveled corner of the processor socket. Important Before removing the processor, remove all memory first. Install the processor, heat sink and clip, then re-install the memory. If the processor is not installed correctly, the system board and the processor can be damaged.
47
Security features
Security features in this section include: Passwords Vital Product Data Management Information Format (MIF) Alert on LAN
Passwords
The following provides information about computer hardware and software-related passwords: Power-on Password Administrator Password Operating System Password Power-on and Administrator passwords are set in the Setup Utility program. See Setup Utility program on page 41 for information about running the Setup Utility.
48
Power-on password: A power-on password denies access to the computer by an unauthorized user when the computer is powered on. When a power-on password is active, the password prompt appears on the screen each time the computer is powered on. The computer starts after the proper password is entered.
Removing a power-on password To service a computer with an active and unknown power-on password, power-off the computer and do the following: Note On some models, this procedure will also remove the administrator password. 1. Unplug the power cord and remove the top cover. 2. Refer to System board layout on page 77 to find the password jumper. 3. Move the password jumper to connect the center pin and the pin on the opposite end of the connector. 4. Power-on the computer. The system senses the change in the position and erases the password. It is necessary to move the jumper back to the previous position. 5. Remind the user to enter a new password when service is complete.
49
Administrator password: The administrator password is used to restrict access to the Configuration/Setup Utility program. If the administrator password is activated, and you do not enter the administrator password, the configuration can be viewed but not changed.
Note Type 6268, 6278, 6288/6338, 2173 has Enhanced Security Mode. If Enhanced Security mode is enabled and there is no password given, the computer will act as if Enhanced Security is disabled. If Enhanced Security is Enabled and an administrator password is given, the administrator password must be entered to use the computer. If the administrator password is lost or forgotten, the system board in the computer must be replaced in order to regain access to the Configuration/Setup Utility program.
Administrator password control The Administrator password is set in the Setup Configuration. Refer to Setup Utility program on page 41 Operating system password: An operating system password is very similar to a power-on password and denies access to the computer by an unauthorized user when the password is activated. The computer is unusable until the password is entered and recognized by the computer.
50
The customer has the option to purchase serial number information and services from Retain-a-Group. It is the customer's responsibility to maintain the MIF file and to inform Retain-a-Group of any changes to the file. Some customers may request their servicers to assist them in maintaining the MIF file when serialized components are replaced during hardware service. This assistance is between the customer and the servicer. The servicer can use the DMI MIF Browser to update the MIF information in the EPROM. It is anticipated that some servicers might charge for this service. To update the EPROM using the DMI MIF Browser: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Click Start from the desktop, then Programs. Select IBM SystemView Agent. Select Serial Number Information icon. Click the plus sign to expand. Select the component you want to view or edit. Double click on the component you want to change. Enter new data in the Value field, then click Apply.
Alert on LAN
Alert on LAN provides notification of changes in the computer, even when the computer power is turned off. Working with DMI and Wake on LAN technologies, Alert on LAN helps to manage and monitor the hardware and software features of the computer. Alert on LAN generates notifications to the server of these occurrences: Computer disconnected from the network Computer unplugged from the power outlet All POST errors Operating system or POST hang condition Alert on LAN events are configured to be Enabled or Disabled from the LAN server only, and not from the computer. See the LAN administrator for configuration status information.
51
IDE Drives
52
AUDIO
RGGL
39 40
IDE INTERFACE
1 2
DC INPUT
5V G G 12V
CD-ROM, PD/CD-ROM Type 2X CD-ROM FRU 06H5906 4X CD-ROM FRU 06H7654 6X CD-ROM 8X CD-ROM 6X PD/CD-ROM 16X Max CD-ROM 24X Max CD-ROM 32X Max CD-ROM 40X Max CD-ROM 48X Max CD-ROM
Primary (Master) : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : :
Secondary (Slave) : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : :
53
BIOS levels
An incorrect level of BIOS can cause false error and unnecessary FRU replacement. Use the following information to determine the current level of BIOS installed in the computer, the latest BIOS available for the computer, and where to obtain the latest level of BIOS. Current Level BIOS information. Run the Configuration Utility to determine the level of BIOS installed. Sources for determining the latest level BIOS available. 1. IBM PC Company Home Page http://www.ibm.com/pc/us/ 2. PC PartnerInfo-Technical Database (CTSTIPS.NSF) 3. HelpCenter 4. Levels 1 and 2 Support 5. RETAIN Sources for obtaining the latest level BIOS available. 1. IBM PC Company Home Page http://www.ibm.com/pc/us/ 2. PC PartnerInfo-Technical Database (CTSTIPS.NSF) 3. HelpCenter 4. Levels 1 and 2 Support To update (flash) the BIOS, see Flash (BIOS/VPD) update procedure on page 55.
54
55
Power management
Power management reduces the power consumption of certain components of the computer such as the system power supply, processor, hard disk drives, and some monitors. Advanced Power Management and Rapid Resume Manager are features of some personal computers.
Automatic configuration and power interface (ACPI) BIOS: Being an ACPI BIOS
system, the operating system is allowed to control the power management features of the computer and the setting for Advanced Power Management (APM) BIOS mode are ignored. Not all operating systems support ACPI BIOS mode.
Energy-saving settings can be viewed and changed by using the Advanced Power Management menu in the Configuration/Setup Utility program. Attention If a device, such as a monitor, does not have power-management capabilities, it can be damaged when exposed to a reduced-power state. Before making energy-saving selections for the monitor, check the documentation supplied with the monitor to see if it supports Display Power Management Signaling (DPMS).
At each level, you can define the amount of energy savings by specifying values for the following options: System Power: Select On for the computer to remain on. Select Off for the computer to shut down. Processor Speed:
56
Set the microprocessor to be disabled, or to run at 1, 10, 25, or 50 percent of its internal clock speed. Display: Set display to be disabled or to be reduced at these power states: Standby: Screen is blank, but can be restored immediately when any activity is detected. Suspend: Monitor uses less power than in Standby mode. Screen image is restored after a few seconds when any activity is detected. Off: Monitor power is off. Press Monitor power button to restore power. On some monitors, you might have to depress the power button twice.
The Automatic Power-On features within the Advanced Power Management menu allow you to enable and disable features that turn the computer on automatically. Serial Port Ring Detect: With this feature set to Enabled and an external modem connected to serial port (COM1), the computer will turn on automatically when a ring is detected on the modem.
57
Modem Ring Detect: With this feature set to Enabled, the computer will turn on automatically when a ring is detected on the internal modem. Wake Up on Alarm: You can specify a date and time at which the computer will be turned on automatically. This can be either a single event or a daily event. Wake on LAN: If the computer has a properly configured token-ring or Ethernet LAN adapter card that is Wake on LAN-enabled and there is remote network management software, you can use the IBM-developed Wake on LAN feature. When you set Wake on LAN to Enabled, the computer will turn on when it receives a specific signal from another computer on the local area network (LAN). For further information, see Wake on LAN on page 59.
Network settings
This section applies only to computers linked to a network. The Configuration/Setup Utility program includes settings that can be enabled and disabled to configure the network interface in the computer. These settings are: Flash over LAN (Update POST/BIOS over Network) Wake on LAN
58
Wake on LAN
This setting is used to enable or disable the IBM-developed Wake on LAN feature. This feature makes it possible for the computer to be turned on remotely by a network server. Remote network management software must be used in conjunction with this feature. To access the Wake on LAN setting: 1. Start the Configuration/Setup Utility program. See Setup Utility program on page 41. 2. Select Advanced Power Management. 3. Select Automatic Power On from the program menu. 4. Select Wake on LAN from the Automatic Power On menu. 5. To enable Wake on LAN, select Enabled. To disable Wake on LAN, select Disabled. 6. Press Esc until you return to the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 7. Before you exit from the program, select Save Settings from the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 8. To exit from the Configuration/Setup Utility program, press Esc and follow the instructions on the screen.
59
Supported memory configuration DIMM sizes of 32 MB, 64 MB, 128 MB, and 256 MB are acceptable. Start filling DIMM socket 0, then 1. Use 3.3 V unbuffered 100 MHz. SDRAM Non-Registered DIMMs only.
60
I/O connectors and removal procedures for the cover, front bezel, EMC shield, CD-ROM drive, front panel, ZIP drive, hard drive, HD/fan/speaker bracket, and power supply are on the following pages.
61
Input/Output connectors
1 1
62
Cover removal
To remove top cover: 1. Remove the three cover thumb screws. 2. Slide cover toward the rear of the chassis about 1-Inch (2 cm) to clear the front panel. 3. Lift cover straight up. To install top cover: 1. Slide cover down onto the chassis about 1-inch (2 cm) from the front flange. 2. Make sure bottom cover slots are engaged on the chassis. 3. Slide cover forward to engage the front cover slots onto the chassis flange. 4. Install the three cover thumb screws.
63
Front bezel
EMC shield
64
To remove the CD-ROM drive: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Disconnect the cables from the CD-ROM drive 3. Remove two screws securing the CD-ROM drive. 4. Pull the CD-ROM drive out of the chassis. Note When connecting the CD-ROM Audio Cable, make sure the cable is routed along the system board near the PCI adapter slots. Continue routing the cable along the system board between the power connector and primary IDE connector and then up to the CD-ROM drive. Do not route the CD-ROM cable near the system board I/O connectors. Note When connecting the EIDE DASD Cable, connect the: Blue connector of cable to the system board Black connector to the master device Gray connector to the slave device Route the signal cables next to the hard drive and toward the bottom of the diskette drive housing.
65
Front panel
To remove the front panel: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Remove the top blank bezel and EMC shield or the CD-ROM drive. Note Depending on which one is installed, the blank bezel and EMC shield or the CD-ROM drive must be removed in order to remove the front panel. 3. Reach inside the chassis and pull apart the two bottom latches inside the front panel while pulling the panel out. The two bottom latches will unlatch from the chassis. 4. Next, pull apart the top two latches from inside the panel while pulling the panel out. 5. To remove the front panel, pivot the bottom of the panel out and down at the same time.
66
Bracket
To remove the hard drive: 1. Press in on both rail tabs and lift the hard drive up then pull it back and out from the bracket. 2. Remove the signal and power cables from top of the hard drive. 3. When replacing the hard drive, remove the drive rails from the old drive and install them on the new drive.
67
To remove the bracket: 1. Remove the hard drive so it will not be damaged from vibration. The hard drive can be removed from the bracket by depressing the hard drive rail tabs, lifting the hard drive up then pulling it back and away from the bracket. See Hard drive removal on page 67. 2. Disconnect the speaker and fan cables from the system board. 3. Remove the two bracket screws at bottom of chassis. 4. Lift the bracket up then pull the bracket out from front of chassis.
68
To remove the power supply: 1. Remove the top cover 2. Remove the thumb screw from the rear of the power supply 3. Push in on the tab then, push up on the power supply bracket and swing it out to disengage the bracket from the chassis.
69
I/O connectors and removal procedures for the cover, front panel, front bezel, diskette/hard drive bracket, CD-ROM drive, and power supply are on the following pages.
70
Input/Output connectors
Serial 2
Parallel
DVI Monitor
2 1
2 1
Serial 1
USB 1
71
Cover removal
To remove top cover: 1. Remove the three cover thumb screws. 2. Slide cover toward the rear of the chassis about 1-Inch (2 cm) to clear the front panel. 3. Lift cover up. To install top cover: 1. Slide cover down onto the chassis about 1-inch (2 cm) from the front panel. 2. Make sure bottom cover slots are engaged on the chassis. 3. Slide cover forward to engage the front cover slots onto the chassis. 4. Install the three cover thumb screws.
72
Front panel
To remove the front panel: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Release the three top latches while gently pulling the top of the panel outward. 3. Keeping the panel at the same angle, gently pull the panel out from the bottom of the chassis. To install the front panel: 1. At the same angle that the panel was when removed, install the bottom tabs of the panel in the chassis. Push up on the left and right bottom tabs, if necessary, to get the tabs in the holes of the chassis. 2. Push the top of the panel toward the chassis until the three top latches lock in place.
73
Front bezel
To remove the front blank bezel: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Remove the front panel. 3. Unlatch the tabs of the bezel and remove it from the panel.
EMC shield
To remove the diskette/hard drive bracket: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Remove the diskette and hard drives or disconnect their cables. 3. Remove the two top screws securing the bracket. 4. Slide bracket toward the back of the chassis to unlatch it from the chassis. 5. Lift the bracket out of the chassis.
74
To remove the CD-ROM drive: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Remove the cables from the CD-ROM drive. 3. Remove two screws securing the CD-ROM drive. 4. Pull the CD-ROM drive out of the chassis. Note When connecting the CD-ROM Audio Cable, make sure the cable is routed along the system board near the PCI adapter slots. Continue routing the cable along the system board between the power connector and primary IDE connector and then up to the CD-ROM drive. Do not route the CD-ROM cable near the system board I/O connectors.
75
76
31
321
77
78
1-2 (D)
Processor Speed Settings Processor speed for the PC 300 type 6268, 6278, 6288/6338, and Aptiva type 2173 computers are fixed and are determined by the processor. There are no settings required. Diskette Write Access Diskette Write Enable and Write Protect options are changed in the Setup Configuration. See Setup Utility program on page 41.
79
Symptom-to-FRU index
The Symptom-to-FRU index lists error symptoms and possible causes. The most likely cause is listed first. Always begin with General checkout on page 24. See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics error codes on page 1 when running diagnostics. This index can also be used to help you decide which FRUs to have available when servicing a computer. If you are unable to correct the problem using this index, go to Undetermined problem on page 102. Notes If you have both an error message and an incorrect audio response, diagnose the error message first. If you cannot run the diagnostic tests or you get a diagnostic error code when running a test, but did receive a POST error message, diagnose the POST error message first. If you did not receive any error message, look for a description of your error symptoms in the first part of this index. Check all power supply voltages before you replace the system board. (See Power supply on page 29.) Check the hard disk drive jumper settings before you replace a hard disk drive. (See Hard disk drive jumper settings on page 52.) Important 1. Some errors are indicated with a series of beep codes. (See Beep symptoms on page 81.) Type 6268/6278/6288/6338/2173 computers default to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 41. 2. The processor is a separate FRU from the system board; the processor is not included with the system board FRU.
80
Beep symptoms
Beep symptoms are short tones or a series of short tones separated by pauses (intervals without sound). See the following examples.
Beeps 1-2-X Description One Beep A pause (or break) Two beeps A pause (or break) Any number of beeps Four continuous beeps FRU/Action 1. Run Setup 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Keyboard 2. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Run Setup 2. System Board 2-1-X First 64 KB of RAM failed. 2-2-2 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Run Setup 2. Memory Module 3. System Board 1. System Board 1. System Board 2. Keyboard 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 3. Display
4 Beep Symptom 1-1-3 CMOS read/write error 1-1-4 ROM BIOS check error 1-2-X DMA error 1-3-X 1-4-4 1-4-X Error detected in first 64 KB of RAM. 2-1-1, 2-1-2
3-1-X DMA register failed. 3-2-4 Keyboard controller failed. 3-3-4 Screen initialization failed.
81
Beep Symptom 3-4-1 Screen retrace test detected an error. 3-4-2 POST is searching for video ROM. 4
FRU/Action 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 3. Display 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board
All other beep code sequences. One long and one short beep during POST. Base 640 KB memory error or shadow RAM error. One long beep and two or three short beeps during POST. (Video error) Three short beeps during POST. Continuous beep. Repeating short beeps.
1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. See System board memory on page 60. 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. Keyboard stuck key? 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board
No beep symptoms
Note Type 6268/6278/6288/6338/2173 computers default to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 41.
Symptom/Error No beep during POST but computer works correctly. FRU/Action 1. System Board
82
FRU/Action 1. See Undetermined problem on page 102. 2. System Board 3. Memory Module 4. Any Adapter or Device 5. Riser Card 6. Power Cord 7. Power Supply
83
02X 08X Check SCSI terminator installation. 101 System board interrupt failure. 102 System board timer error. 106 110 System board memory parity error. 111 I/O channel parity error. 114 Adapter ROM error. 129 Internal cache test error. 151 Real-time clock failure. 161 Bad CMOS battery.
1. System Board
1. System Board 1. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Reseat adapters 2. Any Adapter 3. System Board 1. Adapter Memory 2. System Board 1. Processor 2. L2 Cache Memory 3. System Board 1. System Board 1. Run Setup 2. CMOS Backup Battery (See page Safety information on page 434.) 3. System Board
84
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup and verify Configuration 2. Had a device been added, removed, changed location? If not, suspect that device. 3. Power-on external devices first, then power-on computer. 4. CMOS Backup Battery (See page Safety information on page 434.) 5. System Board 1. Diskette Drive 2. System Board 3. Diskette Drive Cable 1. Time and Date Set? 2. CMOS Backup Battery (See page Safety information on page 434.) 3. System Board 1. Run Setup. Check System Summary menu for memory size change. (See Setup Utility program on page 41.) 2. Run the Extended Memory Diagnostic tests. 1. Run Flash Recovery using Boot Block. See Flash recovery boot block jumper on page 55 2. System Board 1. Run Setup. Check Stepping level for the BIOS level needed, then perform the flash update. 2. Processor 1. Run Setup. Check to see that Ethernet and Alert on LAN are enabled. 2. System Board 1. C2 Security
162 And unable to run diagnostics. 163 Clock not updating or invalid time set.
164 POST detected a base memory or extended memory size mismatch error.
17X, 18X
85
FRU/Action 1. Run Configuration (See Setup Utility program on page 41.) 2. System Board 1. Covers were removed from the computer. 1. System Board
184 Password removed due to check-sum error. 185 Corrupted boot sequence. 186 187
1. Set configuration and reinstall the boot sequence. 1. System Board 1. Clear Administration password 2. System Board 1. More than three password attempts were made to access the computer. 1. System Board
189
190 Chassis intrusion detector was cleared. This is information only, no action required. If this code does not clear: 1XX Not listed above. 201, 20X Memory data error.
1. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diag. Memory Test 2. Memory Module 3. System Board 1. Unsupported Memory 1. L2 Cache Memory 2. System Board
86
POST Error Code 262 POST detected a base memory or extended memory type error.
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup. Check System Summary menu for memory type change. (See Setup Utility program on page 41.) 2. Run the Extended Memory Diagnostic tests. 1. Keyboard 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board 1. 2. 3. 4. Mouse Keyboard Keyboard Cable System Board
301
1. Keyboard 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board 1. Keyboard 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board
601
1. Diskette Drive A 2. Diskette Drive Cable 3. System Board 1. Bad Diskette ? 2. Verify Diskette and retry. 1. Run Setup and verify diskette configuration settings 2. Diskette Drive A/B 3. Diskette Drive Cable 4. System Board 1. Diskette Drive 2. Diskette Drive Cable 3. System Board 1. Diskette drive configuration error or wrong diskette drive type, run Setup Configuration. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Diskette Drive System Board External Drive Adapter Diskette Drive Cable Power Supply
602
87
POST Error Code 762 Math coprocessor configuration error. 7XX Not listed above. 962 Parallel port configuration error. 9XX 1047 107X Check SCSI terminator installation.
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup 2. Processor 3. System Board 1. Processor 2. System Board 1. Run Configuration 2. Parallel Adapter (if installed) 3. System Board 1. Printer 2. System Board 1. 16-Bit AT Fast SCSI Adapter 1. Check SCSI terminator installation. 2. SCSI Cable 3. SCSI Terminator 4. SCSI Device 5. SCSI Adapter 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics
1101 Serial connector error, possible system board failure. 1101, 1102, 1106, 1108, 1109 1107
1. System Board 2. Any Serial Device 1. Communications Cable 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. System Board 1. Serial Device Cable 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Configuration 2. Serial Adapter (if installed) 3. System Board
1102 Card selected feedback error. 1103 Port fails register check. 1106 Serial option cannot be turned off. 1107 1110 Register test failed. 1116 Interrupt error. 1117 Failed baud rate test. 1162 Serial port configuration error.
88
POST Error Code 11XX Not listed above. 1201 1202, 1206, 1208, 1209, 12XX
FRU/Action 1. System Board 1. System Board 2. Any Serial Device 1. Dual Async Adapter/A 2. System Board 3. Any Serial Device 1. Communications Cable 2. Dual Async Adapter/A 1. Game Adapter Information only Information only
1207
13XX 1402 Printer not ready. 1403 No paper error, or interrupt failure. 1404 System board timeout failure. 1405 Parallel adapter error. 1406 Presence test error. 14XX Not listed above. Check printer before replacing system board. 15XX 1692 Boot sequence error. 16XX 1762 Hard disk drive configuration error. 1780 1781 1782 1783 (Disk (Disk (Disk (Disk Drive Drive Drive Drive 0) 1) 2) 3)
1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Printer 2. System Board
1. SDLC Adapter 1. Run FDISK to ensure at least one active partition is set active. 1. 36/38 Workstation Adapter 1. Run Configuration (See Setup Utility program on page 41.) 1. See Power supply on page 29. 2. Hard Disk Drive 3. System Board 4. Hard Disk Cable 5. Power Supply
89
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup and verify PCI/ISA configuration settings. 2. If necessary, set ISA adapters to Not available to allow PCI adapters to properly configure. 3. Remove any suspect ISA adapters. 4. Rerun diagnostics. 5. PCI Adapter 1. Possible hard disk drive problem, see Hard disk drive boot error on page 41. 1. Diskette Drive 2. Diskette Cable 3. 16-bit AT Fast SCSI Adapter 1. BSC Adapter 1. SCSI Device 2. 16-bit AT Fast SCSI Adapter 3. Alternate BSC Adapter 1. Display 1. System Board 2. Display 1. Display 1. System Board 2. Display 1. Check cable connections. 2. Run Setup and verify video configuration settings. 3. Video Memory Modules 4. Video Adapter (if installed) 5. System Board 1. 2. 3. 4. Network Attached? LF Translator Cable Problem PC Network Adapter
209X
2401, 2402 If screen colors change. 2401, 2402 If screen colors are OK. 2409 2410 2462 Video memory configuration error.
3015, 3040 Check for missing wrap or terminator plug on the adapter. 30XX
90
FRU/Action 1. Network Attached? 2. LF Translator 3. Alternate PC Network-Adapter 4. Cable Problem 1. Alternate PC Network Adapter 2. LF Translator 3. Cable Problem 1. GPIB Adapter 1. DAC Adapter 1. Multiport/2 Interface Board 2. Multiport/2 Adapter 1. Memory Module Package 2. Multiport/2 Adapter 1. Multiport Interface Cable 1. Multiport/2 Adapter 2. Multiport/2 Interface Board 3. Memory Module 1. Financial System Controller Adapter 1. 2. 3. 4. Run Configuration CD-ROM Drive CD-ROM Adapter ZIP or other ATAPI device 5. System Board 1. 1st Store Loop Adapter 2. Adapter Cable 1. 2nd Store Loop Adapter 2. Adapter Cable 1. Network Adapter 1. Voice Adapter 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 1. Page Printer Adapter 1. High Speed Adapter 1. 3117 Adapter 1. PCMCIA Adapter 1. Speech Adapter 2. Speech Control Assy. 1. Pointing Device (Mouse) 2. System Board
31XX
5600 5962 An IDE device (other than hard drive) configuration error.
62XX
63XX
64XX 71XX 74XX 76XX 78XX 79XX 80XX 84XX 8601, 8602
91
FRU/Action 1. System Board 2. Pointing Device (Mouse) 1. Mouse 2. System Board 1. PC Music Adapter 2. MIDI Adapter Unit 1. Optical Drive 2. Adapter 1. SCSI Adapter 2. Any SCSI Device 3. System Board
1. Have customer verify correct operating system device drivers are installed and operational. 2. Modem 1. System Board 2. Data/Fax Modem 1. Check system speaker 2. Check PSTN cable 3. External DAA (if installed) 4. Modem 1. Run Diagnostics and verify the correct operation of the modem slot 2. Modem 1. Diagnostics detected a non-IBM modem 2. Modem 1. Check PSTN Cable 2. External DAA (if installed) 3. Modem
10118
10119
10120
1. Modem
1. Data/Fax Modem 2. System Board 1. Modem Adapter/A 2. Data/Fax Modem 3. System Board
92
POST Error Code 10450, 10451, 10490 10491, 10492, 10499 Read/write error. 10452 Seek test error. 10453 Wrong drive type? 10454 Sector buffer test error. 10455, 10456 Controller error. 10459 Drive diagnostic command error. 10461 Drive format error 10462 Controller seek error. 10464 Hard Drive read error. 10467 Drive non fatal seek error. 10468 Drive fatal seek error. 10469 Drive soft error count exceeded. 10470, 10471, 10472 Controller wrap error. 10473 Corrupt data. Low level format might be required. 10480
FRU/Action 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. Hard Disk Drive 3. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics Information only 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics Information only
1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics Information only
1. Hard Disk Drive (ESDI) 2. Drive Cable 3. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Check Configuration 2. Ethernet Adapter 1. Power-off computer, wait ten seconds; then power-on the computer. 2. Ethernet Adapter
10481 ESDI drive D seek error. 10482 Drive select acknowledgement bad. 106X1 10635
93
POST Error Code 10651, 10660 106XX Not listed above. 107XX
FRU/Action 1. Check Cables 2. Ethernet Adapter 1. Ethernet Adapter 1. 5.25-inch External Diskette Drive 2. 5.25-inch Diskette Drive Adapter/A 1. ActionMedia Adapter/A 2. System Board 1. SCSI Adapter 2. Any SCSI Device 3. System Board 1. 3119 Adapter 1. Modem Adapter 2. Any Serial Device 3. System Board 1. ISDN Primary Rate Adapter 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. Realtime Interface Coprocessor Portmaster Adapter/A 1. Japanese Display Adapter 2. System Board 1. System Board Video Adapter 2. Adapter Video Memory 1. Video Adapter 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 3. Display (any type) 1. External Display 2. Video Adapter 1. FaxConcentrator Adapter 1. 120 MB Internal Tape Drive 2. Diskette Cable 3. System Board 1. 6157 Tape Attachment Adapter 1. 6157 Streaming Tape Drive 2. 6157 Tape Attachment Adapter
109XX Check the adapter cables. 112XX This adapter does not have cache. 119XX 121XX
136XX
137XX 141XX
143XX
14710, 14711
94
FRU/Action 1. Token Ring Adapter 2. System Board 1. Wizard Adapter 2. Wizard Adapter Memory 1. Wizard Adapter Cable 1. DBCS Japanese Display Adapter/A 2. System Board 1. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 2. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 2. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 1. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 2. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 2. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 3. System Board 1. Printer/Scanner Option 2. Image Adapter/A 3. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 2. Printer/Scanner Option 3. Image Adapter/A 1. Printer/Scanner Option 2. Image Adapter/A 3. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Replace memory module (shown in graphic.) 1. SCSI-2 Adapter 2. Any SCSI Device 3. System Board 1. Any SCSI Device
20001 to 20003
20004
20005 to 20010
20101 to 20103
20104
20105 to 20110
208XX Verify there are no duplicate SCSI ID settings on the same bus.
95
POST Error Code 210XXXX Internal bus, size unknown. 210XXX1 External bus, size unknown.
FRU/Action 1. SCSI Hard Disk Drive 2. SCSI Adapter or System Board 3. SCSI Cable 4. SCSI ID Switch (on some models) 1. Tape Drive 2. SCSI Cable (internal) 3. SCSI Adapter or System Board 1. Tape Drive 2. SCSI Adapter or System Board 3. SCSI Cable (internal) SCSI Cable (external) 1. Tape Cassette 2. Drive 1. Rotary Switch Circuit Board 2. Circuit Board Cable 3. Tape Drive
Tape automatically ejected from drive. SCSI ID on rotary switch does not match SCSI ID set in configuration. Verify drive switches inside cover are set to zero. Tape sticks/breaks in drive. Verify that the tapes used meet ANSI standard X3B5. 212XX 213XX 214XX 215XXXC 215XXXD 215XXXE 215XXXU If an external device, and power-on LED is off, check external voltages. 216XX 217XX If an external device, and power-on LED is off, check external voltages. 218XX Check for multi CD tray, or juke box. 219XX
1. Tape Cassette
1. SCSI Printer 2. Printer Cable 1. SCSI Processor 1. WORM Drive 1. CD-ROM Drive I CD-ROM Drive II Enhanced CD-ROM Drive II Any CD-ROM Drive 2. SCSI Cable 3. SCSI Adapter or System Board 1. Scanner 1. Rewritable Optical Drive 2. SCSI Adapter or System Board 3. SCSI Cable 1. Changer
96
FRU/Action 1. ISDN/2 Adapter 2. ISDN/2 Wrap Plug 3. ISDN/2 Communications Cable 1. 1 Mbps Micro Channel Infrared LAN Adapter 1. ServerGuard Adapter 2. System Board 1. ServerGuard Adapter
273XX
27501, 27503 27506, 27507 27502, 27504, 27510 27511, 27533, 27534 27536, 27537 27509
1. Remove redundant adapters, run Auto Configuration program, then retest. 1. WMSELF.DGS diagnostics file missing. 2. WMSELF.DGS diagnostics file incorrect. 1. 3V Lithium Backup Battery 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. Internal Temperature out of range 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. ServerGuard Adapter 2. Power Supply 1. 7.2V NiCad Main Battery Pack 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. PCMCIA Type II Modem 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. External Power Control not connected 2. External Power Control 3. ServerGuard Adapter 1. External Power Control 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. Update Diagnostic Software 1. Personal Dictation System Adapter 2. System Board 1. External FRU (Speaker, Microphone)
27512
27535
27554
27563, 27564
27880 to 27889
97
FRU/Action Possible hard disk drive problem, see Hard disk drive boot error on page 41.
98
Changing colors. Computer will not power-off. See Power supply on page 29. Computer will not RPL from server
Dead computer. See Power supply on page 29. Diskette drive in-use light remains on or does not light when drive is active. Flashing cursor with an otherwise blank display.
99
Message/Symptom Insert a Diskette icon appears with a known-good diagnostics diskette in the first 3.5-inch diskette drive. Intensity or color varies from left to right of characters and color bars. No power, or fan not running. Nonsystem disk or disk error-type message with a known-good diagnostic diskette. Other display symptoms not listed above (including blank or illegible display). Power-on indicator or hard disk drive in-use light not on, but computer works correctly. Printer problems. Program loads from the hard disk with a known-good diagnostics diskette in the first 3.5-inch diskette drive. RPL computer cannot access programs from its own hard disk.
FRU/Action 1. 2. 3. 4. Diskette Drive System Board Diskette Drive Cable Network Adapter
1. Display 2. System Board 1. See Power supply on page 29. 1. Diskette Drive 2. System Board 3. Diskette Drive Cable 1. See Display on page 31. 2. System Board 3. Display 1. Power Supply 2. System Board 3. LED Cables 1. See Printer on page 28. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Run Setup Diskette Drive Diskette Drive Cable System Board Power Supply
1. If network admin. is using LCCM Hybrid RPL, check startup sequence: First device: network; Second device: hard disk 2. Hard disk drive 1. Check startup sequence 2. Check the network adapter LED status 1. External Device Self-Test OK? 2. External Device 3. Cable 4. System Board 1. External Device Self-Test OK? 2. External Device 3. Cable 4. Alternate Adapter 5. System Board
100
101
Undetermined problem
Check the power supply voltages. See Power supply on page 29. If the voltages are correct, return here and continue with the following steps. 1. Power-off the computer. 2. Remove or disconnect the following, if installed, one at a time: a. Non-IBM devices b. External devices (modem, printer, or mouse) c. Any adapters d. Riser card e. Memory modules Before removing or replacing memory modules, see System board memory on page 60. f. Extended video memory g. External Cache h. External Cache RAM i. Hard disk drive j. Diskette drive 3. Power-on the computer to re-test the system. 4. Repeat steps 1 through 3 until you find the failing device or adapter. If all devices and adapters have been removed, and the problem continues, replace the system board. See Replacing a system board on page 48.
102
Asia Pacific (AP) AP English w/Keyboard AP English w/o Keyboard Japan (Japanese) Hong Kong (AP English) Hong Kong (Chinese) China (Chinese) China (AP English) Thailand (Thai) Taiwan (Chinese) Taiwan (AP English) Korea (Korean) Korea (AP English)
Model xxA xxB xxJ xxH xxM xxC xxD xxT xxV xxW xxK xxR
103
104
Model
Processor
16X
43X
44X
70X
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 103. Intel Celeron processor comes with 128K Cache. Graphics = 810 Graphics with 4 MB SDRAM display Cache integrated on system board. Audio = integrated on system board. Models 56X, 57X, 58X have PCI Audio adapter. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 104
105
106
Memory 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 128 MB NP 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 10.1 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 40X Max Windows 98 8.4 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 40X Max Windows 98 8.4 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 40X Max Windows 98 13.5 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 40X Max Windows NT 8.4 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 40X Max Windows 98 15.0 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 40X Max Windows 98 13.5 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 40X Max Windows 98 13.5 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 40X Max Windows NT 8.4 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 40X Max Windows 98 Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
S1X
S2X
S3X
S4X
S5X
S6X
S8X
S9X
SAX
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 103. Intel Celeron processor comes with 128K Cache. Graphics = 810 Graphics with 4 MB SDRAM display Cache integrated on system board. Audio = integrated on system board. Models S5X, S6X, S7X, Sex, SJX have Ethernet card. Models S1X, S2X, S3X, S4X, S8X, SDX, SGX, have modem. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 104
Model
Processor
SBX
SDX
SEx
SFX
SGX
SJX
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 103. Intel Celeron processor comes with 128K Cache. Graphics = 810 Graphics with 4 MB SDRAM display Cache integrated on system board. Audio = integrated on system board. Models S5X, S6X, S7X, Sex, SJX have Ethernet card. Models S1X, S2X, S3X, S4X, S8X, SDX, SGX, have modem. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 104
107
108
Memory 32 MB NP 32 MB NP 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 32 MB NP 32 MB NP 32 MB NP 64 MB NP 5.0 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A Windows 98 5.0 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A Windows 98 8.4 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A Windows 98 8.4 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A Windows 98 8.4 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A Windows 95 8.4 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A Windows 98 8.4 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A Windows 98 Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
10X
11X
15X
16X
17X
1CX
1DX
1EX
1FX
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 103. Intel Celeron processor comes with 128K Cache. Graphics = 810 Graphics with 4 MB SDRAM display Cache integrated on system board. Audio = integrated on system board. Models 39X, 40X, 70X, 78X, have Ethernet card Models 56X, 57X, 58X have PCI Audio adapter. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 104
Model
Processor
1GX
1HX
30X
31X
35X
36X
37X
39X
40X
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 103. Intel Celeron processor comes with 128K Cache. Graphics = 810 Graphics with 4 MB SDRAM display Cache integrated on system board. Audio = integrated on system board. Models 39X, 40X, 70X, 78X, have Ethernet card Models 56X, 57X, 58X have PCI Audio adapter. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 104
109
110
Memory 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 64 MB NP 10.1 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A Windows 98 13.5 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 40X Max Windows NT 13.5 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 40X Max Windows 98 13.5 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A Windows NT 13.5 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A Windows 98 13.5 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 40X Max Windows NT 8.4 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 40X Max Windows NT Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
41X
42X
44X
45X
46X
47X
48X
49X
50X
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 103. Intel Celeron processor comes with 128K Cache. Graphics = 810 Graphics with 4 MB SDRAM display Cache integrated on system board. Audio = integrated on system board. Models 39X, 40X, 70X, 78X, have Ethernet card Models 56X, 57X, 58X have PCI Audio adapter. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 104
Model
Processor
51X
53X
70X
71X
72X
73X
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 103. Intel Celeron processor comes with 128K Cache. Graphics = 810 Graphics with 4 MB SDRAM display Cache integrated on system board. Audio = integrated on system board. Models 39X, 40X, 70X, 78X, have Ethernet card Models 56X, 57X, 58X have PCI Audio adapter. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 104
111
112
Memory 64 MB NP N/A 32 MB NP 64 MB NP 15.0 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 40X Max Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A Windows 98 N/A 810 Graphics 4X4 N/A N/A 15.0 GB EIDE 810 Graphics 4X4 40X Max Windows NT Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
74X
76X
78X
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 103. Intel Celeron processor comes with 128K Cache. Graphics = 810 Graphics with 4 MB SDRAM display Cache integrated on system board. Audio = integrated on system board. Models 39X, 40X, 70X, 78X, have Ethernet card Models 56X, 57X, 58X have PCI Audio adapter. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 104
Notes:
113
7 9 8 10 16 15 14 13 12 11
21
20 18 19
114
17
Parts listing
Index 1 2 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 8 9 10 11 12 12 12 12 13 14 15 16 17 17 17 18 19 19 19 19 20 20 21 System (Type 6268/6278/2173) Top Cover CD-ROM Drive (32X Max) (Young Explorer Little Tikes) CD-ROM Drive (40X Max) Front Bezel (Panel) assembly EMC Shield for 5.25-inch Bay Blank Bezel 5.25-inch Door Assembly Blank Door Bezel 1.44 MB, 3.5-Inch Diskette Drive 1.44 MB, 3.5-Inch Diskette Drive (Japan) Speaker/Cable Assembly Fan with mounting supports Hard Disk Mounting Bracket 8.4 GB7 EIDE Hard Disk Drive 10.1 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 13.5 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 15.0 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive Hard Drive Rails (Qty 2) System Board (no processor, no memory) Ethernet Adapter - Lake Clark 2.3 Power Supply Bracket Power Supply-145W Power Supply-145W (China) Power Supply-145W (Japan) Fan Duct Intel Celeron Processor 433 MHz, 128 KB cache Intel Celeron Processor 466 MHz, 128 KB cache Intel Celeron Processor 500 MHz, 128 KB cache Intel Celeron Processor 533 MHz, 128 KB cache Memory - 64 MB DIMM, Non-Parity Memory - 128 MB DIMM, Non-Parity Base Frame Assembly Audio Adapter - PCI Audio Adapter (Young Explorer Little Tikes) Cable - CD-ROM Audio Cable - CD-ROM, IDE ATA (2 drop) Cable - Diskette Drive Cable - Hard Disk Cable, ATA Cable - Wake On Ring EMC Shield Kit for System Board FRU No. 37L2499 02K1115 36L8713 37L2505 20L3073 37L2508 37L2506 37L2507 75H9550 75H9552 01K4909 37L4526 37L2501 36L8679 36L8681 36L8689 09N0851 01K1539 01N2845 30L5929 37L2502 01K9870 36L8815 20L2314 37L2512 37L2476 37L2494 00N6101 09N4424 01K1147 01K1148 37L2500 37L4457 02K3457 75H9219 37L5098 01K1513 37L4525 76H7345 37L2503
When referring to hard-disk-drive capacity, GB means 1 000 000 000 bytes; total user-accessible capacity may vary depending on operating environment. 8 MHz measures internal clock speed of the microprocessor only; not application performance. Many factors affect application performance.
115
Index
System (Type 6268/6278/2173) Foot (4) Heatsink/Clip for Celeron processor LED/Power Switch Assembly Lithium Battery Miscellaneous Hardware Kit Modem - Domestic (2173, 6278) Modem - Universal - EMEA and Asia Pacific South (2173, 6278) Mouse - 2 button (6268, 2173) Mouse - Scrollpoint (6278) Microphone (Aptiva 2173 only) Name Plate-Aptiva (Aptiva 2173 only) Name Plate (6268, 6278) Power Button (6268, 6278, 2173) Speakers - Set (Aptiva 2173 only) Speaker Brick-Power module (China) (Aptiva 2173 only) Speaker Brick-Power module (HongKong) (Aptiva 2173 only) URM retainer Kit
FRU No. 03K9655 09N4375 37L2511 33F8354 20L3094 01N2833 01N2834 10L6145 28L1865 01N1961 01N3057 37L2509 10K1701 01N1845 20L2174 20L2172 33L4521
116
15
14
13
12
11
10
8 9
117
Parts listing
Index 1 2 2 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 8 9 9 9 9 9 10 11 11 12 13 13 13 13 13 14 15 15 System (Type 6288/6338) Top Cover Power Supply-145W Power Supply-145W (China) Power Supply-145W (Japan) Air Duct Hard Disk/Floppy Bracket Front Bezel (Panel) Assembly Bezel Kit CD-ROM (40X Max) 1.44 MB, 3.5-Inch Diskette Drive 1.44 MB, 3.5-Inch Diskette Drive (Japan) 5.0 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 8.4 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 10.1 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 13.5 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 15.0 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive Fan/Card Guide Assembly Memory - 32 MB DIMM, Non-Parity Memory - 64 MB DIMM, Non-Parity System Board (no processor, no memory) Intel Celeron Processor 400 MHz, 128 KB cache Intel Celeron Processor 433 MHz, 128 KB cache Intel Celeron Processor 466 MHz, 128 KB cache Intel Celeron Processor 500 MHz, 128 KB cache Intel Celeron Processor 533 MHz, 128 KB cache Base Frame Assembly Ethernet Adapter - Lake Clark 2.3 Audio adapter - PCI Cable - CD-ROM Audio Cable - ATA-66 2 Drop Cable - Diskette Drive Cable - Hard Disk Cable, ATA Cable - Wake On Ring EMC Shield for 5.25-inch bay EMC Shield Kit for System Board Foot (4) Heatsink/Clip for Celeron processor LED/Power Switch Assembly Lithium Battery Miscellaneous Hardware Kit Modem - domestic Mouse - 2 button Nameplate, PC 300 GL (6288, 6338) Power Button (6288, 6338) Speaker Speaker with Cable Assembly URM retainer Kit X-wide upper bay bezel X-wide lower bay bezel FRU No. 09K9825 01K9870 36L8815 20L2314 09N4512 37L5094 37L5096 37L5097 36L8713 75H9550 75H9552 09N0967 36L8679 36L8681 36L8689 09N0851 37L5093 01K1146 01K1147 01N2845 37L2474 37L2476 37L2494 00N6101 09N4424 09N4508 30L5929 37L4457 75H9219 37L5098 33L2596 37L4525 76H7345 20L3073 37L5095 03K9655 09N4375 37L5092 33F8354 20L3094 01N2833 10L6145 00N6083 10K1705 20L2168 01K4909 33L4521 10K1707 10K1709
118
119
Display and Monitor Information Display and monitor information is separately available and is listed under Related publications on page v.
Special tools
The following tools are required to service these computers: A volt-ohm meter, IBM P/N 73G5404 Wrap Plug, IBM P/N 72X8546
120
121
Iomega Zip Drive Test . . . . . . . . . . . . Asset EEPROM backup . . . . . . . . . . . Viewing the test log . . . . . . . . . . . . . SIMM/DIMM memory errors . . . . . . . . Setup Utility program . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hard disk drive boot error . . . . . . . . . . When to use the Low-Level Format program . Preparing the hard disk drive for use . . . . . Product description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Specifications Type 6563/6593 . . . . . . . . Specifications Type 6564/6574 Aptiva 2178/2198 Additional service information . . . . . . . . . . Replacing a processor . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacing a system board . . . . . . . . . . Security features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Passwords . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power-on password . . . . . . . . . . . . Administrator password . . . . . . . . . . Administrator password control . . . . . . Operating system password . . . . . . . . Vital product data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Management Information Format (MIF) . . . . Alert on LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hard disk drive jumper settings . . . . . . . . IDE hard disk drive settings . . . . . . . . CD-ROM drive jumper settings . . . . . . . . BIOS levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flash (BIOS/VPD) update procedure . . . . . Flash recovery boot block . . . . . . . . . . Power management . . . . . . . . . . . . . Advanced Configuration and Power Interface (ACPI) BIOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Advanced Power Management . . . . . . Automatic Hardware Power Management features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting Automatic Hardware Power Management features . . . . . . . . . . Automatic Power-On features . . . . . . . Network settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flash over LAN (update POST/BIOS over network) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Wake on LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System board memory . . . . . . . . . . . . Computer exploded view (Type 6563/6593) . . . . Input/Output connectors . . . . . . . . . . . Cover removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front bezel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EMC shield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Diskette/hard drive bracket . . . . . . . . . . CD-ROM drive removal . . . . . . . . . . . Power supply removal . . . . . . . . . . . . Computer exploded view (Type 6564/6574/2178/2198) . . . . . . . . . . . . .
138 138 139 139 141 141 142 142 143 144 145 146 146 147 147 147 148 149 149 149 149 149 150 151 151 152 153 154 154 155 155 155 155 156 156 157 157 158 159 160 161 162 163 164 164 164 165 166 167
122
Input/Output connectors . . . . . . . . . . . Cover removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front bezel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EMC shield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CD-ROM drive removal . . . . . . . . . . . Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ZIP drive removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hard drive removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . HD/fan/speaker bracket removal . . . . . . . Power supply removal . . . . . . . . . . . . System board layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System board locations . . . . . . . . . . . System board switch settings . . . . . . . . . Symptom-to-FRU index . . . . . . . . . . . . . Beep symptoms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . No beep symptoms . . . . . . . . . . . . . POST error codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Miscellaneous error messages . . . . . . . . Undetermined problem . . . . . . . . . . . . . Model tables - Country/Region/Language . . . . . Type/Model configuration tables (6563/6564/6574) Parts (Type 6563, 6593) . . . . . . . . . . . . . Parts listing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Parts (Type 6564/6574) . . . . . . . . . . . . . Parts listing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Parts (Type 2178/2198) . . . . . . . . . . . . . Parts listing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Special tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
168 169 170 170 171 172 173 173 174 175 176 177 178 179 180 181 183 198 201 202 203 219 220 222 223 227 228 231
123
General checkout
This general checkout procedure is for Type 6563/6593/6564/6574 and 2178/2198 computers. Attention The drives in the computer you are servicing might have been re-arranged or the drive startup sequence changed. Be extremely careful during write operations such as copying, saving, or formatting. Data or programs can be overwritten if you select an incorrect drive. Diagnostic error messages appear when a test program finds a problem with a hardware option. For the test programs to properly determine if a test Passed, Failed, or Aborted, the test programs check the error-return code at test completion. See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics on page 134. General error messages appear if a problem or conflict is found by an application program, the operating system, or both. For an explanation of these messages, refer to the information supplied with that software package. Notes 1. Before replacing any FRUs, ensure the latest level of BIOS is installed on the system. A down-level BIOS might cause false errors and unnecessary replacement of the system board. For more information on how to determine and obtain the latest level BIOS, see BIOS levels on page 153. 2. If multiple error codes are displayed, diagnose the first error code displayed. 3. If the computer hangs with a POST error, go to Symptom-to-FRU index on page 179. 4. If the computer hangs and no error is displayed, go to Undetermined problem on page 201. 5. If an installed device is not recognized by the diagnostics program, that device might be defective. The power-on default is quick bring-up. To enable Enhanced bring-up, select the Start Options in the Configuration/Setup Utility program (see Setup Utility program on page 141) then, enable Power On Status. 001 Power-off the computer and all external devices. Check all cables and power cords. Make sure the system board is seated properly. Set all display controls to the middle position. (Step 001 continues)
124
001 (continued) Insert the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics diskette into drive A. Power-on all external devices. Power-on the computer. Check for the following response: 1. Readable instructions or the Main Menu. Note Type 6563/6593/6564/6574 and 2178/2198 computers default to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 141. DID YOU RECEIVE THE CORRECT RESPONSE? Yes No 002 If the Power Management feature is enabled, do the following: 1. Start the Configuration/Setup Utility program (see Setup Utility program on page 141) 2. Select Power Management from the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 3. Select APM 4. Be sure APM BIOS Mode is set to Disabled. If it is not, press Left Arrow ( ) or Right Arrow ( ) to change the setting. 5. Select Automatic Hardware Power Management. 6. Set Automatic Hardware Power Management to Disabled. or Go to the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics on page 134. 003 Run the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics test. If necessary, refer to Diagnostics and test information on page 132. If you receive an error, replace the part that the diagnostic program calls out or go to IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics on page 134. If the test stops and you cannot continue, replace the last device tested. If the computer has incorrect keyboard responses, go to Keyboard on page 128. (Step 003 continues)
125
(CONTINUED)
003 (continued) If the printer has incorrect responses, go to Printer on page 128. If the display has problems such as jittering, rolling, shifting, or being out of focus, go to Display on page 131.
126
127
Keyboard
Note If a mouse or other pointing device is attached, remove it to see if the error symptom goes away. If the symptom goes away, the mouse or pointing device is defective. 001 Power-off the computer. Disconnect the keyboard cable from the system unit. Power-on the computer and check the keyboard cable connector on the system unit for the voltages shown. All voltages are 5%.
Pin 1 2 3 4
5
6
6 4 2
5 3 1
ARE THE VOLTAGES CORRECT? Yes No 002 Replace the system board. 003 On keyboards with a detachable cable, replace the cable. If the problem remains or if the cable is permanently attached to the keyboard, replace the keyboard. If the problem remains, replace the system board.
Printer
1. Make sure the printer is properly connected and powered on. 2. Run the printer self-test. If the printer self-test does not run correctly, the problem is in the printer. Refer to the printer service manual. If the printer self-test runs correctly, install a wrap plug in the parallel port and run the diagnostic tests to determine which FRU failed. If the diagnostic tests (with the wrap plug installed) do not detect a failure, replace the printer cable. If that does not correct the problem, replace the system board or adapter connected to the printer cable.
128
Power supply
If the power-on indicator is not on, the power-supply fan is not running, or the computer will not power-off, do the following.
Check/Verify 1. Verify that the voltage-selector switch is set for the correct voltage. 2. Check the following for proper installation. Power Cord On/Off Switch connector On/Off Switch Power Supply connector System Board Power Supply connectors microprocessor(s) connection 3. Check the power cord for proper continuity. 4. Check the power-on switch for continuity. FRU/Action Correct the voltage-selector switch setting. Reseat
129
11
20
Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
Signal 3.3 V 3.3 V COM 5V COM 5V COM POK 5VSB 12 V 3.3 V -12 V COM PS-ON COM COM COM not used 5V 5V
Function +3.3 V dc +3.3 V dc Ground +5 V dc Ground +5 V dc Ground Power Good Standby Voltage +12 V dc +3.3 V dc -12 V dc Ground DC Remote Enable Ground Ground Ground not used +5 V dc +5 V dc
If the voltages are not correct, and the power cord is good, replace the power supply.
130
Display
If the screen is rolling, replace the display assembly. If that does not correct the problem, replace the video adapter (if installed) or replace the system board. If the screen is not rolling, do the following to run the display self-test: 1. 2. 3. 4. Power-off the computer and display. Disconnect the display signal cable. Power-on the display. Turn the brightness and contrast controls clockwise to their maximum setting. 5. Check for the following conditions: You should be able to vary the screen intensity by adjusting the contrast and brightness controls. The screen should be white or light gray, with a black margin (test margin) on the screen. Note The location of the test margin varies with the type of display. The test margin might be on the top, bottom, or one or both sides. If you do not see any test margin on the screen, replace the display. If there is a test margin on the screen, replace the video adapter (if installed) or replace the system board. Note During the first two or three seconds after the display is powered on, the following might occur while the display synchronizes with the computer. Unusual patterns or characters Static, crackling, or clicking sounds A power-on hum on larger displays A noticeable odor might occur on new displays or displays recently removed from storage. These sounds, display patterns, and odors are normal; do not replace any parts. If you are unable to correct the problem, go to Undetermined problem on page 201.
131
132
Note Type 6563/6593/6564/6574 and 2178/2198 computers default to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: 1. Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 141.
RDDDPLSCB QEET Test state Error code Extension Qualifier Bus ( =internal 1=external) Capacity of the device Slot number of the device LUN (usually ) PUN (SCSI ID #) Device Number Reserved Digit (usually )
133
This diagnostic diskette includes: A new user interface (WaterGate Software's PC-Doctor) This interface serves as the control program for running both the IBM PC Enhanced Memory Diagnostics and the suite of diagnostic tests provided by PC-Doctor. IBM PC PC Enhanced Memory Diagnostics The memory diagnostic tests determine which memory module (SIMM or DIMM) is defective and report the socket where the failing module is located. The Memory diagnostics can run a quick and full test of the system. Diagnostics can also be run on a single SIMM or DIMM. Note See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnosticsfor the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics error codes.
134
Use the cursor movement keys to navigate within the menus. The Enter key is used to select a menu item. The Esc key is used to back up to the previous menu. For online help select F1.
Test selection
To select one or more tests: 1. Open the corresponding test category. 2. Using the cursor movement keys, highlight the desired test. 3. Press Space bar. A selected test is marked with a chevron, >>. Pressing the space bar again de-selects a test and removes the chevron. 4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 above to select all desired tests.
135
1. Select the DIAGNOSTICS option on the toolbar and press Enter. 2. Highlight either the 'Memory Test-Full' or 'Memory Test-Quick option and press Enter. Memory Test-Full The full memory test will take about 80 seconds per MB of memory and will detect marginal, intermittent, and solid (stuck) memory failures. Memory Test-Quick The quick memory test will take about 20 seconds per MB of memory and will detect solid (stuck) memory failures only. Notes Either level of memory testing can be performed on all memory or a single SIMM/DIMM socket. Only sockets containing a SIMM or DIMM can be selected for testing. Unpopulated sockets are noted by ........ besides the test description.
Asset ID test
The Asset ID test does the following: Determines if Asset ID is supported on the system. Verifies the EEPROM areas. Performs an antenna detection test.
Test results
IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostic test results will produce this error code format:
Function Failure Code Type DeviceID Date ChkDigits Text
Represents the feature or function within the PC. Represents the type of error encountered. Contains the component's unit-id which corresponds to either a fixed disk drive, removable media drive, serial or parallel port, processor, specific DIMM, or a device on the PCI bus.
136
Date:
ChkDigits:
Text: Note
Contains the date on which the diagnostic test was run. Date is retrieved from CMOS and displayed using the YYYYMMDD format. Contains a 2-digit check-digit value to ensure that: Diagnostics were run on the specified date Diagnostics were run on the specified IBM computer The diagnostic error code is recorded correctly Description of the error.
See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics error codes on page 1 for error code listings.
137
138
SIMM/DIMM memory errors: SIMM/DIMM error messages issued by the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics:
Message 2xx-1y Failure Found A memory error was detected in SIMM socket Y Recommended Actions Replace the SIMM in the socket identified by the last digit of the error code. Re-run the test. If the same error code occurs again, replace the system board. 2xx-2y A memory error was detected in DIMM socket Y Replace the DIMM in the socket identified by the last digit of the error code. Re-run the test. If the same error code occurs again, replace the system board or where memory is on the processor card, replace the processor card. Corrupt BIOS Information in BIOS is not as expected. Not able to find expected DMI information from BIOS. Memory controller chipset vendor ID does not match expected value. Reflash the BIOS. Perform boot block recovery. Replace the system board.
139
"Y" is the SIMM/DIMM socket number. Use the System Board Layouts section in the latest Hardware Maintenance Manual, HMM, to reference the memory sockets.
140
141
Actions The drive must be formatted, do the following: 1. Attempt to access and recover (back-up) the failing hard disk drive. 2. Using the operating systems programs, format the hard disk drive. 3. Go to Preparing the hard disk drive for use on page 142.
142
Product description
The PC 300 Type 6563/6593/6564/6574 and Aptiva 2178/2198 computers are available in 4 x 4, (Four drive bays, four I/O adapter slots) as desktop and micro-tower models. Note Service information is the same for PC 300 types 6563/6564/6574 and Aptiva 2178/2198 computers, unless specifically identified as type 6563 which is the desktop computer or type 2178/2198 which are the Aptiva micro-tower computers. Type 6563/6593 is the desktop Type 6564 and 6574 are the micro-tower Aptiva Type 2178/2198 are the micro-tower Security Administrator password Cover lock Power-on password Operating system password U-bolt and cable (Optional for some models) C2 security on some models
CMOS backup battery (lithium) Common parts (Varies with each model, see Type/Model configuration tables (6563/6564/6574) on page 203.) Diskette drive Hard disk drive Keyboard Power supply Mouse
Specifications Information (ISO/ANSI) The model specifications information on the following pages was determined in controlled acoustical environments according to procedures specified by the American National Standards Institute (ANSI) S12.10 and ISO 7779, and are reported in accordance with ISO 9296. Actual sound pressure levels in your location might differ from the average values stated because of room reflections and other nearby noise sources. The declared sound power levels indicate an upper limit, below which a large proportion of machines will operate.
143
Weight Environment
Heat Output
Electrical Input
Maximum configuration weight depends on options installed. Figures above are a system fully populated with options. 10 Maximum power and heat specifications are based on the 145-watt maximum capacity of the system power supply. 11 For additional information, see the ISO Supplier's Declaration available from IBM.
144
Weight Environment
Heat Output
Electrical Input
145
Replacing a processor
Make sure the processor is fully seated in its socket and that the goal post latches are engaged. Important Make sure the air baffle is installed to prevent processor overheating. If the processor is not installed correctly, the system board and the processor can be damaged.
146
Security features
Security features in this section include: Passwords Vital Product Data Management Information Format (MIF) Alert on LAN
Passwords
The following provides information about computer hardware and software-related passwords: Power-on Password Administrator Password Operating System Password Power-on and Administrator passwords are set in the Setup Utility program. See Setup Utility program on page 141 for information about running the Setup Utility.
147
Power-on password: A power-on password denies access to the computer by an unauthorized user when the computer is powered on. When a power-on password is active, the password prompt appears on the screen each time the computer is powered on. The computer starts after the proper password is entered.
Removing a power-on password To service a computer with an active and unknown power-on password, power-off the computer and do the following: Attention This procedure will remove the administrator password. Also, this procedure will clear all setup parameters, privilege access, and boot sequence settings. Make sure these setting are recorded before performing this procedure. 1. Unplug the power cord and remove the top cover. 2. Refer to System board layout on page 176 to find the switch assembly 1 (SW1). 3. Move switch 2 (SW1-2) from the OFF position to the ON (CMOS clear) position. 4. Power-on the computer. The system senses the change in the position and erases the password. 5. There will be no video. Wait for the system to produce two POST beeps, then power-off and unplug the power cord. 6. Move switch 2 (SW1-2) from the ON (CMOS clear) position to the OFF (original) position. 7. Power-on the system. 8. The system should now produce a video signal and two POST beeps, along with a 162 configuration error. 9. Reset the date and time and follow the on-screen instructions to reconfigure the computer. 10. Remind the user to enter a new password when service is complete.
148
Administrator password: The administrator password is used to restrict access to the Configuration/Setup Utility program. If the administrator password is activated, and you do not enter the administrator password, the configuration can be viewed but not changed.
Note Type 6563, 6564, and 6574 have Enhanced Security Mode. If Enhanced Security mode is enabled and there is no password given, the computer will act as if Enhanced Security is disabled. If Enhanced Security is Enabled and an administrator password is given, the administrator password must be entered to use the computer. If the administrator password is lost or forgotten, the system board in the computer must be replaced in order to regain access to the Configuration/Setup Utility program.
Operating system password: An operating system password is very similar to a power-on password and denies access to the computer by an unauthorized user when the password is activated. The computer is unusable until the password is entered and recognized by the computer.
149
The customer has the option to purchase serial number information and services from Retain-a-Group. It is the customer's responsibility to maintain the MIF file and to inform Retain-a-Group of any changes to the file. Some customers may request their servicers to assist them in maintaining the MIF file when serialized components are replaced during hardware service. This assistance is between the customer and the servicer. The servicer can use the DMI MIF Browser to update the MIF information in the EPROM. It is anticipated that some servicers might charge for this service. To update the EPROM using the DMI MIF Browser: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Click Start from the desktop, then Programs. Select IBM SystemView Agent. Select Serial Number Information icon. Click the plus sign to expand. Select the component you want to view or edit. Double click on the component you want to change. Enter new data in the Value field, then click Apply.
Alert on LAN
Alert on LAN provides notification of changes in the computer, even when the computer power is turned off. Working with DMI and Wake on LAN technologies, Alert on LAN helps to manage and monitor the hardware and software features of the computer. Alert on LAN generates notifications to the server of these occurrences: Computer disconnected from the network Computer unplugged from the power outlet All POST errors Operating system or POST hang condition Alert on LAN events are configured to be Enabled or Disabled from the LAN server only, and not from the computer. See the LAN administrator for configuration status information.
150
IDE Drives
151
AUDIO
RGGL
39 40
IDE INTERFACE
1 2
DC INPUT
5V G G 12V
CD-ROM, PD/CD-ROM Type 2X CD-ROM FRU 06H5906 4X CD-ROM FRU 06H7654 6X CD-ROM 8X CD-ROM 6X PD/CD-ROM 16X Max CD-ROM 24X Max CD-ROM 32X Max CD-ROM 40X Max CD-ROM 48X Max CD-ROM
Primary (Master) : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : :
Secondary (Slave) : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : :
152
BIOS levels
An incorrect level of BIOS can cause false error and unnecessary FRU replacement. Use the following information to determine the current level of BIOS installed in the computer, the latest BIOS available for the computer, and where to obtain the latest level of BIOS. Current Level BIOS information. Run the Configuration Utility to determine the level of BIOS installed. Sources for determining the latest level BIOS available. 1. IBM PC Company Home Page http://www.ibm.com/pc/us/ 2. PC PartnerInfo-Technical Database (CTSTIPS.NSF) 3. HelpCenter 4. Levels 1 and 2 Support 5. RETAIN Sources for obtaining the latest level BIOS available. 1. IBM PC Company Home Page http://www.ibm.com/pc/us/ 2. PC PartnerInfo-Technical Database (CTSTIPS.NSF) 3. HelpCenter 4. Levels 1 and 2 Support To update (flash) the BIOS, see Flash (BIOS/VPD) update procedure on page 154.
153
154
Power management
Power management reduces the power consumption of certain components of the computer such as the system power supply, processor, hard disk drives, and some monitors. Advanced Power Management and Rapid Resume Manager are features of some personal computers.
Advanced Configuration and Power Interface (ACPI) BIOS: Being an ACPI BIOS
system, the operating system is allowed to control the power management features of the computer and the setting for Advanced Power Management (APM) BIOS mode are ignored. Not all operating systems support ACPI BIOS mode.
Energy-saving settings can be viewed and changed by using the Advanced Power Management menu in the Configuration/Setup Utility program. Attention If a device, such as a monitor, does not have power-management capabilities, it can be damaged when exposed to a reduced-power state. Before making energy-saving selections for the monitor, check the documentation supplied with the monitor to see if it supports Display Power Management Signaling (DPMS).
At each level, you can define the amount of energy savings by specifying values for the following options: System Power: Select On for the computer to remain on. Select Off for the computer to shut down. Display:
155
Set display to be disabled or to be reduced at these power states: Standby: Screen is blank, but can be restored immediately when any activity is detected. Suspend: Monitor uses less power than in Standby mode. Screen image is restored after a few seconds when any activity is detected. Off: Monitor power is off. Press Monitor power button to restore power. On some monitors, you might have to depress the power button twice.
The Automatic Power-On features within the Advanced Power Management menu allow you to enable and disable features that turn the computer on automatically. Serial Port Ring Detect: With this feature set to Enabled and an external modem connected to serial port (COM1), the computer will turn on automatically when a ring is detected on the modem. PCI Modem Ring Detect: With this feature set to Enabled, the computer will turn on automatically when a ring is detected on the internal modem. Wake Up on Alarm: You can specify a date and time at which the computer will be turned on automatically. This can be either a single event or a daily event.
156
PCI Wake Up: The computer can be automatically powered on from any PCI device that will generate a Wake Up event. Wake on LAN: If the computer has a properly configured token-ring or Ethernet LAN adapter card that is Wake on LAN-enabled and there is remote network management software, you can use the IBM-developed Wake on LAN feature. When you set Wake on LAN to Enabled, the computer will turn on when it receives a specific signal from another computer on the local area network (LAN). For further information, see Wake on LAN on page 158.
Network settings
This section applies only to computers linked to a network. The Configuration/Setup Utility program includes settings that can be enabled and disabled to configure the network interface in the computer. These settings are: Flash over LAN (Update POST/BIOS over Network) Wake on LAN
157
Wake on LAN
This setting is used to enable or disable the IBM-developed Wake on LAN feature. This feature makes it possible for the computer to be turned on remotely by a network server. Remote network management software must be used in conjunction with this feature. To access the Wake on LAN setting: 1. Start the Configuration/Setup Utility program. See Setup Utility program on page 141. 2. Select Advanced Power Management. 3. Select Automatic Power On from the program menu. 4. Select Wake on LAN from the Automatic Power On menu. 5. To enable Wake on LAN, select Enabled. To disable Wake on LAN, select Disabled. 6. Press Esc until you return to the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 7. Before you exit from the program, select Save Settings from the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 8. To exit from the Configuration/Setup Utility program, press Esc and follow the instructions on the screen.
158
Memory Module Size 64 MB 128 MB 256 MB 512 MB 1 GB Maximum Speed 133 MHz Type SDRAM ECC/ Non-Parity Industry Standard
Memory Module Size 64 MB 128 MB 256 MB 512 MB Maximum Speed 133 MHz Type SDRAM Non-Parity Industry Standard
Supported memory configuration DIMM sizes of 64 MB, 128 MB, and 256 MB are acceptable. Start filling DIMM socket 0, then 1. Use 3.3 V unbuffered 133 MHz. SDRAM Non-Registered DIMMs only.
159
I/O connectors and removal procedures for the cover, front panel, front bezel, diskette/hard drive bracket, CD-ROM drive, and power supply are on the following pages.
160
Input/Output connectors
Serial 2
Parallel
DVI Monitor
2 1
2 1
Serial 1
USB 1
161
Cover removal
To remove top cover: 1. Remove the three cover thumb screws. 2. Slide cover toward the rear of the chassis about 1-Inch (2 cm) to clear the front panel. 3. Lift cover up. To install top cover: 1. Slide cover down onto the chassis about 1-inch (2 cm) from the front panel. 2. Make sure bottom cover slots are engaged on the chassis. 3. Slide cover forward to engage the front cover slots onto the chassis. 4. Install the three cover thumb screws.
162
Front panel
To remove the front panel: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Release the three top latches while gently pulling the top of the panel outward. 3. Keeping the panel at the same angle, gently pull the panel out from the bottom of the chassis. To install the front panel: 1. At the same angle that the panel was when removed, install the bottom tabs of the panel in the chassis. Push up on the left and right bottom tabs, if necessary, to get the tabs in the holes of the chassis. 2. Push the top of the panel toward the chassis until the three top latches lock in place.
163
Front bezel
To remove the front blank bezel: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Remove the front panel. 3. Unlatch the tabs of the bezel and remove it from the panel.
EMC shield
To remove the diskette/hard drive bracket: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Remove the diskette and hard drives or disconnect their cables. 3. Remove the two top screws securing the bracket. 4. Slide bracket toward the back of the chassis to unlatch it from the chassis. 5. Lift the bracket out of the chassis.
164
To remove the CD-ROM drive: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Remove the cables from the CD-ROM drive. 3. Remove two screws securing the CD-ROM drive. 4. Pull the CD-ROM drive out of the chassis. Note When connecting the CD-ROM Audio Cable, make sure the cable is routed along the system board near the PCI adapter slots. Continue routing the cable along the system board between the power connector and primary IDE connector and then up to the CD-ROM drive. Do not route the CD-ROM cable near the system board I/O connectors.
165
166
I/O connectors and removal procedures for the cover, front bezel, EMC shield, CD-ROM drive, front panel, ZIP drive, hard drive, HD/fan/speaker bracket, and power supply are on the following pages.
167
Input/Output connectors
Serial 2
Serial 1
1 1
2 2
DVI Monitor
168
Cover removal
To remove top cover: 1. Remove the three cover thumb screws. 2. Slide cover toward the rear of the chassis about 1-Inch (2 cm) to clear the front panel. 3. Lift cover straight up. To install top cover: 1. Slide cover down onto the chassis about 1-inch (2 cm) from the front flange. 2. Make sure bottom cover slots are engaged on the chassis. 3. Slide cover forward to engage the front cover slots onto the chassis flange. 4. Install the three cover thumb screws.
169
Front bezel
EMC shield
170
To remove the CD-ROM drive: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Disconnect the cables from the CD-ROM drive 3. Remove two screws securing the CD-ROM drive. 4. Pull the CD-ROM drive out of the chassis. Note When connecting the CD-ROM Audio Cable, make sure the cable is routed along the system board near the PCI adapter slots. Continue routing the cable along the system board between the power connector and primary IDE connector and then up to the CD-ROM drive. Do not route the CD-ROM cable near the system board I/O connectors. Note When connecting the EIDE DASD Cable, connect the: Blue connector of cable to the system board Black connector to the master device Gray connector to the slave device Route the signal cables next to the hard drive and toward the bottom of the diskette drive housing.
171
Front panel
To remove the front panel: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Remove the top blank bezel and EMC shield or the CD-ROM drive. Note Depending on which one is installed, the blank bezel and EMC shield or the CD-ROM drive must be removed in order to remove the front panel. 3. Reach inside the chassis and pull apart the two bottom latches inside the front panel while pulling the panel out. The two bottom latches will unlatch from the chassis. 4. Next, pull apart the top two latches from inside the panel while pulling the panel out. 5. To remove the front panel, pivot the bottom of the panel out and down at the same time.
172
Bracket
To remove the hard drive: 1. Press in on both rail tabs and lift the hard drive up then pull it back and out from the bracket. 2. Remove the signal and power cables from top of the hard drive. 3. When replacing the hard drive, remove the drive rails from the old drive and install them on the new drive.
173
To remove the bracket: 1. Remove the hard drive so it will not be damaged from vibration. The hard drive can be removed from the bracket by depressing the hard drive rail tabs, lifting the hard drive up then pulling it back and away from the bracket. See Hard drive removal on page 173. 2. Disconnect the speaker and fan cables from the system board. 3. Remove the two bracket screws at bottom of chassis. 4. Lift the bracket up then pull the bracket out from front of chassis.
174
To remove the power supply: 1. Remove the top cover 2. Remove the thumb screw from the rear of the power supply 3. Push in on the tab then, push up on the power supply bracket and swing it out to disengage the bracket from the chassis.
175
176
177
Switch (SW2) Note Switch (SW2) is a reserved eight position switch block. Switches can either be in the Off or in the On position.
Processor Speed Settings Processor speed for the PC 300 type 6563/6593, 6564, 6574 and Aptiva type 2178/2198 computers are fixed and are determined by the processor. There are no settings required.
178
Symptom-to-FRU index
The Symptom-to-FRU index lists error symptoms and possible causes. The most likely cause is listed first. Always begin with General checkout on page 124. See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics error codes on page 1 when running diagnostics. This index can also be used to help you decide which FRUs to have available when servicing a computer. If you are unable to correct the problem using this index, go to Undetermined problem on page 201. Notes If you have both an error message and an incorrect audio response, diagnose the error message first. If you cannot run the diagnostic tests or you get a diagnostic error code when running a test, but did receive a POST error message, diagnose the POST error message first. If you did not receive any error message, look for a description of your error symptoms in the first part of this index. Check all power supply voltages before you replace the system board. (See Power supply on page 129.) Check the hard disk drive jumper settings before you replace a hard disk drive. (See Hard disk drive jumper settings on page 151.) Important 1. Some errors are indicated with a series of beep codes. (See Beep symptoms on page 180.) Type 6563/6593/6564/6574 and Aptiva type 2178/2198 computers default to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 141. 2. The processor is a separate FRU from the system board; the processor is not included with the system board FRU.
179
Beep symptoms
Beep symptoms are short tones or a series of short tones separated by pauses (intervals without sound). See the following examples.
Beeps 1-2-X Description One Beep A pause (or break) Two beeps A pause (or break) Any number of beeps Four continuous beeps FRU/Action 1. Run Setup 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Keyboard 2. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Run Setup 2. System Board 2-1-X First 64 KB of RAM failed. 2-2-2 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Run Setup 2. Memory Module 3. System Board 1. System Board 1. System Board 2. Keyboard 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 3. Display
4 Beep Symptom 1-1-3 CMOS read/write error 1-1-4 ROM BIOS check error 1-2-X DMA error 1-3-X 1-4-4 1-4-X Error detected in first 64 KB of RAM. 2-1-1, 2-1-2
3-1-X DMA register failed. 3-2-4 Keyboard controller failed. 3-3-4 Screen initialization failed.
180
Beep Symptom 3-4-1 Screen retrace test detected an error. 3-4-2 POST is searching for video ROM. 4
FRU/Action 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 3. Display 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board
All other beep code sequences. One long and one short beep during POST. Base 640 KB memory error or shadow RAM error. One long beep and two or three short beeps during POST. (Video error) Three short beeps during POST.
1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. See System board memory on page 159. 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. Keyboard stuck key? 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board
No beep symptoms
Note Type 6563/6593/6564/6574 and Aptiva type 2178/2198 computers default to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 141.
Symptom/Error No beep during POST but computer works correctly. FRU/Action 1. System Board
181
FRU/Action 1. See Undetermined problem on page 201. 2. System Board 3. Memory Module 4. Any Adapter or Device 5. Power Cord 6. Power Supply
182
02X 08X Check SCSI terminator installation. 101 System board interrupt failure. 102 System board timer error. 106 110 System board memory parity error. 111 I/O channel parity error. 114 Adapter ROM error. 129 Internal cache test error. 151 Real-time clock failure. 161 Bad CMOS battery.
1. System Board
1. System Board 1. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Reseat adapters 2. Any Adapter 3. System Board 1. Adapter Memory 2. System Board 1. Processor 2. L2 Cache Memory 3. System Board 1. System Board 1. Run Setup 2. CMOS Backup Battery (See page Safety information on page 434.) 3. System Board
183
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup and verify Configuration 2. Had a device been added, removed, changed location? If not, suspect that device. 3. Power-on external devices first, then power-on computer. 4. CMOS Backup Battery (See page Safety information on page 434.) 5. System Board 1. Diskette Drive 2. System Board 3. Diskette Drive Cable 1. Time and Date Set? 2. CMOS Backup Battery (See page Safety information on page 434.) 3. System Board 1. Run Setup. Check System Summary menu for memory size change. (See Setup Utility program on page 141.) 2. Run the Extended Memory Diagnostic tests. 1. Run Flash Recovery using Boot Block. See Flash recovery boot block on page 154 2. System Board 1. Run Setup. Check Stepping level for the BIOS level needed, then perform the flash update. 2. Processor 1. Run Setup. Check to see that Ethernet and Alert on LAN are enabled. 2. System Board 1. C2 Security
162 And unable to run diagnostics. 163 Clock not updating or invalid time set.
164 POST detected a base memory or extended memory size mismatch error.
17X, 18X
184
FRU/Action 1. Run Configuration (See Setup Utility program on page 141.) 2. System Board 1. Covers were removed from the computer. 1. System Board
184 Password removed due to check-sum error. 185 Corrupted boot sequence. 186 187
1. Set configuration and reinstall the boot sequence. 1. System Board 1. Clear Administration password 2. System Board 1. More than three password attempts were made to access the computer. 1. System Board
189
190 Chassis intrusion detector was cleared. This is information only, no action required. If this code does not clear: 1XX Not listed above. 201, 20X Memory data error.
1. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diag. Memory Test 2. Memory Module 3. System Board 1. Unsupported Memory 1. L2 Cache Memory 2. System Board
185
POST Error Code 262 POST detected a base memory or extended memory type error.
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup. Check System Summary menu for memory type change. (See Setup Utility program on page 141.) 2. Run the Extended Memory Diagnostic tests. 1. Keyboard 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board 1. 2. 3. 4. Mouse Keyboard Keyboard Cable System Board
301
1. Keyboard 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board 1. Keyboard 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board
601
1. Diskette Drive A 2. Diskette Drive Cable 3. System Board 1. Bad Diskette ? 2. Verify Diskette and retry. 1. Run Setup and verify diskette configuration settings 2. Diskette Drive A/B 3. Diskette Drive Cable 4. System Board 1. Diskette Drive 2. Diskette Drive Cable 3. System Board 1. Diskette drive configuration error or wrong diskette drive type, run Setup Configuration. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Diskette Drive System Board External Drive Adapter Diskette Drive Cable Power Supply
602
186
POST Error Code 762 Math coprocessor configuration error. 7XX Not listed above. 962 Parallel port configuration error. 9XX 1047 107X Check SCSI terminator installation.
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup 2. Processor 3. System Board 1. Processor 2. System Board 1. Run Configuration 2. Parallel Adapter (if installed) 3. System Board 1. Printer 2. System Board 1. 16-Bit AT Fast SCSI Adapter 1. Check SCSI terminator installation. 2. SCSI Cable 3. SCSI Terminator 4. SCSI Device 5. SCSI Adapter 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics
1101 Serial connector error, possible system board failure. 1101, 1102, 1106, 1108, 1109 1107
1. System Board 2. Any Serial Device 1. Communications Cable 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. System Board 1. Serial Device Cable 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Configuration 2. Serial Adapter (if installed) 3. System Board
1102 Card selected feedback error. 1103 Port fails register check. 1106 Serial option cannot be turned off. 1107 1110 Register test failed. 1116 Interrupt error. 1117 Failed baud rate test. 1162 Serial port configuration error.
187
POST Error Code 11XX Not listed above. 1201 1202, 1206, 1208, 1209, 12XX
FRU/Action 1. System Board 1. System Board 2. Any Serial Device 1. Dual Async Adapter/A 2. System Board 3. Any Serial Device 1. Communications Cable 2. Dual Async Adapter/A 1. Game Adapter Information only Information only
1207
13XX 1402 Printer not ready. 1403 No paper error, or interrupt failure. 1404 System board timeout failure. 1405 Parallel adapter error. 1406 Presence test error. 14XX Not listed above. Check printer before replacing system board. 15XX 1692 Boot sequence error. 16XX 1762 Hard disk drive configuration error. 1780 1781 1782 1783 (Disk (Disk (Disk (Disk Drive Drive Drive Drive 0) 1) 2) 3)
1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Printer 2. System Board
1. SDLC Adapter 1. Run FDISK to ensure at least one active partition is set active. 1. 36/38 Workstation Adapter 1. Run Configuration (See Setup Utility program on page 141.) 1. See Power supply on page 129. 2. Hard Disk Drive 3. System Board 4. Hard Disk Cable 5. Power Supply
188
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup and verify PCI/ISA configuration settings. 2. If necessary, set ISA adapters to Not available to allow PCI adapters to properly configure. 3. Remove any suspect ISA adapters. 4. Rerun diagnostics. 5. PCI Adapter 1. Possible hard disk drive problem, see Hard disk drive boot error on page 141. 1. Diskette Drive 2. Diskette Cable 3. 16-bit AT Fast SCSI Adapter 1. BSC Adapter 1. SCSI Device 2. 16-bit AT Fast SCSI Adapter 3. Alternate BSC Adapter 1. Display 1. System Board 2. Display 1. Display 1. System Board 2. Display 1. Check cable connections. 2. Run Setup and verify video configuration settings. 3. Video Memory Modules 4. Video Adapter (if installed) 5. System Board 1. 2. 3. 4. Network Attached? LF Translator Cable Problem PC Network Adapter
209X
2401, 2402 If screen colors change. 2401, 2402 If screen colors are OK. 2409 2410 2462 Video memory configuration error.
3015, 3040 Check for missing wrap or terminator plug on the adapter. 30XX
189
FRU/Action 1. Network Attached? 2. LF Translator 3. Alternate PC Network-Adapter 4. Cable Problem 1. Alternate PC Network Adapter 2. LF Translator 3. Cable Problem 1. GPIB Adapter 1. DAC Adapter 1. Multiport/2 Interface Board 2. Multiport/2 Adapter 1. Memory Module Package 2. Multiport/2 Adapter 1. Multiport Interface Cable 1. Multiport/2 Adapter 2. Multiport/2 Interface Board 3. Memory Module 1. Financial System Controller Adapter 1. 2. 3. 4. Run Configuration CD-ROM Drive CD-ROM Adapter ZIP or other ATAPI device 5. System Board 1. 1st Store Loop Adapter 2. Adapter Cable 1. 2nd Store Loop Adapter 2. Adapter Cable 1. Network Adapter 1. Voice Adapter 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 1. Page Printer Adapter 1. High Speed Adapter 1. 3117 Adapter 1. PCMCIA Adapter 1. Speech Adapter 2. Speech Control Assy. 1. Pointing Device (Mouse) 2. System Board
31XX
5600 5962 An IDE device (other than hard drive) configuration error.
62XX
63XX
64XX 71XX 74XX 76XX 78XX 79XX 80XX 84XX 8601, 8602
190
FRU/Action 1. System Board 2. Pointing Device (Mouse) 1. Mouse 2. System Board 1. PC Music Adapter 2. MIDI Adapter Unit 1. Optical Drive 2. Adapter 1. SCSI Adapter 2. Any SCSI Device 3. System Board
1. Have customer verify correct operating system device drivers are installed and operational. 2. Modem 1. System Board 2. Data/Fax Modem 1. Check system speaker 2. Check PSTN cable 3. External DAA (if installed) 4. Modem 1. Run Diagnostics and verify the correct operation of the modem slot 2. Modem 1. Diagnostics detected a non-IBM modem 2. Modem 1. Check PSTN Cable 2. External DAA (if installed) 3. Modem
10118
10119
10120
1. Modem
1. Data/Fax Modem 2. System Board 1. Modem Adapter/A 2. Data/Fax Modem 3. System Board
191
POST Error Code 10450, 10451, 10490 10491, 10492, 10499 Read/write error. 10452 Seek test error. 10453 Wrong drive type? 10454 Sector buffer test error. 10455, 10456 Controller error. 10459 Drive diagnostic command error. 10461 Drive format error 10462 Controller seek error. 10464 Hard Drive read error. 10467 Drive non fatal seek error. 10468 Drive fatal seek error. 10469 Drive soft error count exceeded. 10470, 10471, 10472 Controller wrap error. 10473 Corrupt data. Low level format might be required. 10480
FRU/Action 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. Hard Disk Drive 3. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics Information only 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics Information only
1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics Information only
1. Hard Disk Drive (ESDI) 2. Drive Cable 3. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Check Configuration 2. Ethernet Adapter 1. Power-off computer, wait ten seconds; then power-on the computer. 2. Ethernet Adapter
10481 ESDI drive D seek error. 10482 Drive select acknowledgement bad. 106X1 10635
192
POST Error Code 10651, 10660 106XX Not listed above. 107XX
FRU/Action 1. Check Cables 2. Ethernet Adapter 1. Ethernet Adapter 1. 5.25-inch External Diskette Drive 2. 5.25-inch Diskette Drive Adapter/A 1. ActionMedia Adapter/A 2. System Board 1. SCSI Adapter 2. Any SCSI Device 3. System Board 1. 3119 Adapter 1. Modem Adapter 2. Any Serial Device 3. System Board 1. ISDN Primary Rate Adapter 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. Realtime Interface Coprocessor Portmaster Adapter/A 1. Japanese Display Adapter 2. System Board 1. System Board Video Adapter 2. Adapter Video Memory 1. Video Adapter 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 3. Display (any type) 1. External Display 2. Video Adapter 1. FaxConcentrator Adapter 1. 120 MB Internal Tape Drive 2. Diskette Cable 3. System Board 1. 6157 Tape Attachment Adapter 1. 6157 Streaming Tape Drive 2. 6157 Tape Attachment Adapter
109XX Check the adapter cables. 112XX This adapter does not have cache. 119XX 121XX
136XX
137XX 141XX
143XX
14710, 14711
193
FRU/Action 1. Token Ring Adapter 2. System Board 1. Wizard Adapter 2. Wizard Adapter Memory 1. Wizard Adapter Cable 1. DBCS Japanese Display Adapter/A 2. System Board 1. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 2. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 2. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 1. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 2. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 2. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 3. System Board 1. Printer/Scanner Option 2. Image Adapter/A 3. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 2. Printer/Scanner Option 3. Image Adapter/A 1. Printer/Scanner Option 2. Image Adapter/A 3. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Replace memory module (shown in graphic.) 1. SCSI-2 Adapter 2. Any SCSI Device 3. System Board 1. Any SCSI Device
20001 to 20003
20004
20005 to 20010
20101 to 20103
20104
20105 to 20110
208XX Verify there are no duplicate SCSI ID settings on the same bus.
194
POST Error Code 210XXXX Internal bus, size unknown. 210XXX1 External bus, size unknown.
FRU/Action 1. SCSI Hard Disk Drive 2. SCSI Adapter or System Board 3. SCSI Cable 4. SCSI ID Switch (on some models) 1. Tape Drive 2. SCSI Cable (internal) 3. SCSI Adapter or System Board 1. Tape Drive 2. SCSI Adapter or System Board 3. SCSI Cable (internal) SCSI Cable (external) 1. Tape Cassette 2. Drive 1. Rotary Switch Circuit Board 2. Circuit Board Cable 3. Tape Drive
Tape automatically ejected from drive. SCSI ID on rotary switch does not match SCSI ID set in configuration. Verify drive switches inside cover are set to zero. Tape sticks/breaks in drive. Verify that the tapes used meet ANSI standard X3B5. 212XX 213XX 214XX 215XXXC 215XXXD 215XXXE 215XXXU If an external device, and power-on LED is off, check external voltages. 216XX 217XX If an external device, and power-on LED is off, check external voltages. 218XX Check for multi CD tray, or juke box. 219XX
1. Tape Cassette
1. SCSI Printer 2. Printer Cable 1. SCSI Processor 1. WORM Drive 1. CD-ROM Drive I CD-ROM Drive II Enhanced CD-ROM Drive II Any CD-ROM Drive 2. SCSI Cable 3. SCSI Adapter or System Board 1. Scanner 1. Rewritable Optical Drive 2. SCSI Adapter or System Board 3. SCSI Cable 1. Changer
195
FRU/Action 1. ISDN/2 Adapter 2. ISDN/2 Wrap Plug 3. ISDN/2 Communications Cable 1. 1 Mbps Micro Channel Infrared LAN Adapter 1. ServerGuard Adapter 2. System Board 1. ServerGuard Adapter
273XX
27501, 27503 27506, 27507 27502, 27504, 27510 27511, 27533, 27534 27536, 27537 27509
1. Remove redundant adapters, run Auto Configuration program, then retest. 1. WMSELF.DGS diagnostics file missing. 2. WMSELF.DGS diagnostics file incorrect. 1. 3V Lithium Backup Battery 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. Internal Temperature out of range 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. ServerGuard Adapter 2. Power Supply 1. 7.2V NiCad Main Battery Pack 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. PCMCIA Type II Modem 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. External Power Control not connected 2. External Power Control 3. ServerGuard Adapter 1. External Power Control 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. Update Diagnostic Software 1. Personal Dictation System Adapter 2. System Board 1. External FRU (Speaker, Microphone)
27512
27535
27554
27563, 27564
27880 to 27889
196
FRU/Action Possible hard disk drive problem, see Hard disk drive boot error on page 141.
197
Changing colors. Computer will not power-off. See Power supply on page 129. Computer will not RPL from server
Dead computer. See Power supply on page 129. Diskette drive in-use light remains on or does not light when drive is active. Flashing cursor with an otherwise blank display.
198
Message/Symptom Insert a Diskette icon appears with a known-good diagnostics diskette in the first 3.5-inch diskette drive. Intensity or color varies from left to right of characters and color bars. No power, or fan not running. Nonsystem disk or disk error-type message with a known-good diagnostic diskette. Other display symptoms not listed above (including blank or illegible display). Power-on indicator or hard disk drive in-use light not on, but computer works correctly. Printer problems. Program loads from the hard disk with a known-good diagnostics diskette in the first 3.5-inch diskette drive. RPL computer cannot access programs from its own hard disk.
FRU/Action 1. 2. 3. 4. Diskette Drive System Board Diskette Drive Cable Network Adapter
1. Display 2. System Board 1. See Power supply on page 129. 1. Diskette Drive 2. System Board 3. Diskette Drive Cable 1. See Display on page 131. 2. System Board 3. Display 1. Power Supply 2. System Board 3. LED Cables 1. See Printer on page 128. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Run Setup Diskette Drive Diskette Drive Cable System Board Power Supply
1. If network admin. is using LCCM Hybrid RPL, check startup sequence: First device: network; Second device: hard disk 2. Hard disk drive 1. Check startup sequence 2. Check the network adapter LED status 1. External Device Self-Test OK? 2. External Device 3. Cable 4. System Board 1. External Device Self-Test OK? 2. External Device 3. Cable 4. Alternate Adapter 5. System Board
199
200
Undetermined problem
Check the power supply voltages. See Power supply on page 129. If the voltages are correct, return here and continue with the following steps. 1. Power-off the computer. 2. Remove or disconnect the following, if installed, one at a time: a. Non-IBM devices b. External devices (modem, printer, or mouse) c. Any adapters d. Memory modules Before removing or replacing memory modules, see System board memory on page 159. e. Extended video memory f. External Cache g. External Cache RAM h. Hard disk drive i. Diskette drive 3. Power-on the computer to re-test the system. 4. Repeat steps 1 through 3 until you find the failing device or adapter. If all devices and adapters have been removed, and the problem continues, replace the system board. See Replacing a system board on page 147.
201
Asia Pacific (AP) AP English w/Keyboard AP English w/o Keyboard Japan (Japanese) Hong Kong (AP English) Hong Kong (Chinese) China (Chinese) China (AP English) Thailand (Thai) Taiwan (Chinese) Taiwan (AP English) Korea (Korean) Korea (AP English)
Model xxA xxB xxJ xxH xxM xxC xxD xxT xxV xxW xxK xxR
202
203
204
Memory N/A 64 MB 64 MB 64 MB 64 MB 64 MB 64 MB N/A 64 MB 64 MB 64 MB 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 40X Max Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 N/A Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 N/A Windows NT N/A N/A 4X4 N/A N/A 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 N/A Windows NT 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 N/A Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 40X Max Windows NT 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 40X Max Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 N/A Windows NT 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 N/A Windows 98 N/A N/A 4X4 N/A N/A Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
450 MHz
22X
450 MHz
23X
450 MHz
24X
450 MHz
25X
450 MHz
26X
450 MHz
27X
450 MHz
500 MHz
42X
500 MHz
43X
500 MHz
44X
500 MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 202. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 203
Model
Processor
45X
500 MHz
47X
500 MHz
533EB MHz
62X
533EB MHz
63X
533EB MHz
64X
533B MHz
65X
533B MHz
66X
533EB MHz
67X
533EB MHz
68X
533EB MHz
69X
533EB MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 202. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 203
205
206
Memory N/A N/A N/A 128 MB 128 MB 64 MB 64 MB 64 MB 64 MB 64 MB 64 MB 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 8MB 4X4 N/A Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 8MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 N/A Windows NT 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 N/A Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 N/A N/A 4X4 N/A N/A N/A N/A 4X4 N/A N/A N/A N/A 4X4 N/A N/A Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
800 MHz
866 MHz
600EB MHz
82X
600EB MHz
83X
600EB MHz
84X
600EB MHz
85X
600EB MHz
86X
600EB MHz
87X
600EB MHz
88X
600EB MHz
8AX
600EB MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 202. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 203
Model
Processor
8BX
600EB MHz
8CX
600B MHz
8DX
600B MHz
667 MHz
91X
667 MHz
92X
667 MHz
93X
667 MHz
94X
667 MHz
95X
667 MHz
96X
667 MHz
733 MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 202. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 203
207
208
Memory 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 64 MB 15 GB EIDE S3/Diamond AGP4 - 8 MB 4X4 N/A Windows 98 20.4 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT 20.4 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 2000 15 GB EIDE NVidia AGP4 - 32 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT 15 GB EIDE NVidia AGP4 - 32 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 15 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 8 MB 4X4 N/A Windows 2000 15 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 8 MB 4X4 N/A Windows NT 15 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 8 MB 4X4 N/A Windows 98 Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
9AX
667 MHz
9BX
667 MHz
9CX
667 MHz
9DX
667 MHz
9EX
667 MHz
9FX
600B MHz
A1X
733 MHz
A2X
733 MHz
A3X
733 MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 202. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 203
Model
Processor
A4X
733 MHz
A5X
733 MHz
A6X
733 MHz
B1X
800 MHz
B2X
800 MHz
C1X
866 MHz
C2X
866 MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 202. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 203
209
210
Memory 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 20.4 GB EIDE S3/Diamond AGP4 - 8 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT 20.4 GB EIDE S3/Diamond AGP4 - 8 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 30 GB EIDE NVidia AGP4 - 32 MB 4X4 R/W CD-ROM Windows NT 30 GB EIDE NVidia AGP4 - 32 MB 4X4 R/W CD-ROM Windows NT 30 GB EIDE NVidia AGP4 - 32 MB 4X4 R/W CD-ROM Windows NT 30 GB EIDE NVidia AGP4 - 32 MB 4X4 R/W CD-ROM Windows 98 Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
P1X
733 MHz
P2X
733 MHz
P3X
733 MHz
P5X
733 MHz
R1X
667 MHz
R2X
667 MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 202. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Models P1X, P2X, R1X, R2X, S4X, S7X, S8X, S9X, SAX, SCX, SDX, SGX, SHX, SKX, SLX, SMX, SPX, SQX, SSX, STX, SWX, T3X, T4X, come with LC 2.3 Ethernet card Models P5X, R3X, R4X, S3X, S6X, SBX, SEx, SJX, SNX, SRX, SUx, SYX come with a modem. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 203
Model
Processor
R3X
667 MHz
R4X
667 MHz
S3X
450 MHz
S4X
450 MHz
S6X
500 MHz
S7X
500 MHz
S8X
500 MHz
S9X
533 MHz
SAX
533 MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 202. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Models P1X, P2X, R1X, R2X, S4X, S7X, S8X, S9X, SAX, SCX, SDX, SGX, SHX, SKX, SLX, SMX, SPX, SQX, SSX, STX, SWX, T3X, T4X, come with LC 2.3 Ethernet card Models P5X, R3X, R4X, S3X, S6X, SBX, SEx, SJX, SNX, SRX, SUx, SYX come with a modem. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 203
211
212
Memory 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 64 MB 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 27.2 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16 MB 4X4 R/W CD Windows 98 27.2 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 27.2 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16 MB 4X4 RWCD Windows NT 27.2 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16 MB 4X4 R/W CD Windows NT 27.2 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16 MB 4X4 R/W CD Windows 98 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 27.2 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16 MB 4X4 R/W CD Windows NT 27.2 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16 MB 4X4 R/W CD Windows NT 27.2 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16 MB 4X4 R/W CD Windows 98 20.4 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
SBX
533 MHz
SCX
600EB MHz
SDX
600EB MHz
SEx
600EB MHz
SFX
500 MHz
SGX
600B MHz
SHX
600B MHz
SJX
600B MHz
SKX
600B MHz
SLX
667 MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 202. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Models P1X, P2X, R1X, R2X, S4X, S7X, S8X, S9X, SAX, SCX, SDX, SGX, SHX, SKX, SLX, SMX, SPX, SQX, SSX, STX, SWX, T3X, T4X, come with LC 2.3 Ethernet card Models P5X, R3X, R4X, S3X, S6X, SBX, SEx, SJX, SNX, SRX, SUx, SYX come with a modem. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 203
Model
Processor
SMX
667 MHz
SNX
667 MHz
SPX
533EB MHz
SQX
533EB MHz
SRX
533EB MHz
SSX
667 MHz
STX
667 MHz
SUx
600B MHz
SV(J)
600B MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 202. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Models P1X, P2X, R1X, R2X, S4X, S7X, S8X, S9X, SAX, SCX, SDX, SGX, SHX, SKX, SLX, SMX, SPX, SQX, SSX, STX, SWX, T3X, T4X, come with LC 2.3 Ethernet card Models P5X, R3X, R4X, S3X, S6X, SBX, SEx, SJX, SNX, SRX, SUx, SYX come with a modem. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 203
213
214
Memory 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 64 MB 64 MB 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 20.4 GB EIDE NVidia AGP4 - 32 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 2000 30 GB EIDE NVidia AGP4 - 32 MB 4X4 R/W CD-ROM Windows NT 30 GB EIDE NVidia AGP4 - 32 MB 4X4 R/W CD-ROM Windows NT Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
SWX
800 MHz
SXX
800 MHz
SYX
667 MHz
T3X
600B MHz
T4X
600B MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 202. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Models P1X, P2X, R1X, R2X, S4X, S7X, S8X, S9X, SAX, SCX, SDX, SGX, SHX, SKX, SLX, SMX, SPX, SQX, SSX, STX, SWX, T3X, T4X, come with LC 2.3 Ethernet card Models P5X, R3X, R4X, S3X, S6X, SBX, SEx, SJX, SNX, SRX, SUx, SYX come with a modem. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 203
Model
Processor
450 MHz
23X
450 MHz
28X
450 MHz
45X
500 MHz
47X
500 MHz
500 MHz
533EB MHz
61X
533EB MHz
62X
533EB MHz
800 MHz
866 MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 202. Processor = Pentium III with 512 KB L2 Cache. Audio = integrated on system board. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 203
215
216
Memory N/A 128 MB 128 MB N/A 128 MB 128 MB N/A 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 20.4 GB EIDE NVidia AGP4 - 32 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 20.4 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT 20.4 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 N/A N/A 4X4 N/A N/A 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT N/A N/A 4X4 N/A N/A 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16 MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 N/A N/A 4X4 N/A N/A Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
600EB MHz
82X
600EB MHz
83X
600EB MHz
667 MHz
91X
667 MHz
92X
667 MHz
733 MHz
A1X
733 MHz
A2X
733 MHz
A3X
733 MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 202. Processor = Pentium III with 512 KB L2 Cache. Audio = integrated on system board. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 203
Model
Processor
A4X
733 MHz
B1X
800 MHz
B2X
800 MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 202. Processor = Pentium III with 512 KB L2 Cache. Audio = integrated on system board. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 203
217
Notes:
218
6 7 13 12 11 10 9
15
14
219
Parts listing
Index 1 2 2 2 3 4 5 6 System (Type 6563) Top Cover Assembly Power Supply-145W Power Supply-145W (China) Power Supply-145W (Japan) Fan Duct Kit Hard File/Floppy Bracket Bezel Kit CD-ROM (40X Max) primary Order either of the below 40X MAX CD-ROM optional drives. CD-ROM (40X Max) optional CD-ROM (40X Max) optional CD-ROM (48X Max) CD-ROM Read/Write 1.44 MB, 3.5-Inch Diskette Drive 1.44 MB, 3.5-Inch Diskette Drive (Japan) 5.0 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 10.1 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 13.0 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 13.5 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 15 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive Order either of the below 20.4 GB hard drives 20.4 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 20.4 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive Front Bezel Assembly Fan/Card Guide Assembly Memory - 64 MB SDRAM, Non-Parity Memory - 128 MB SDRAM, Non-Parity System Board - for 500/533/600B processors (no processor, no memory) System Board - for 533EB/600EB and higher processors (no processor, no memory) Pentium III 450/100 MHz. Pentium III 500/100 MHz. Pentium III 533/133 MHz. Pentium III 533EB MHz. Pentium III 550/100 MHz. Pentium III 600B/133 MHz. Pentium III 600EB MHz Pentium III 667 MHz Pentium III 733 MHz Pentium III 800 MHz Pentium III 866 MHz Chassis Assembly Ethernet Adapter - Lake Clark 2.3 Ethernet Adapter - Accton Cable - ATA-66 2 Drop Cable - CD-ROM Audio Cable - Diskette Drive Cable - Hard Disk Cable, ATA Cable - Wake On Ring EMC Shield Kit for System Board Foot (4) EMC Shield for 5.25-inch Bay LED/Power Switch Assembly FRU No. 09K9825 01K9870 36L8815 20L2314 09N4512 37L5094 37L5097 36L8789
6 6 6 6 7 7 8 8 8 8 8
09N0879 09N0889 09N0735 36L8719 75H9550 75H9552 09N0967 36L8681 09N0873 36L8689 09N0851
8 8 9 10 11 11 12 12
13 13 13 13 13 13 13 13 13 13 13 14 15 15
00N3878 00N3879 33L4066 09N3462 37L5603 01N2657 37L6034 00N3622 00N7174 09N9097 09N4877 09N4508 30L5929 01N3003 37L5098 75H9219 33L2596 37L4525 76H7345 37L5095 03K9655 20L3073 37L5092
220
Index
System (Type 6563) Lithium Battery Miscellaneous Hardware Kit Mouse - 2 button Name Plate (6563) NVidia AGP4 32 MB Video Card Power Button Savage2 Video Card-143 4xAGP Savage4 Video Card -100 2xAGP Video Card 4xAGP Dongle S3 Diamond Video Card Speaker/Cable Assembly URM retainer Kit X-wide upper bay bezel X-wide lower bay bezel
FRU No. 33F8354 20L3094 10L6145 00n6083 10K1291 10K1705 33L1618 09N5898 09N3435 10K2940 01K4909 33L4521 10K1707 10K1709
221
7 9 8 10 16 15 14 13 12 11
21
20 18 19
222
17
Parts listing
Index 1 System (Type 6564, 6574) Top Cover Assembly Order either of the below 40X Max CD-ROM Drives CD-ROM (40X Max) primary Order either of the below 40X MAX CD-ROM optional drives. CD-ROM (40X Max) optional CD-ROM (40X Max) optional CD-ROM (48X Max) (Order either of the Read/Write CD-ROM drives below that match the FRU number of the drive being replaced) CD-ROM (Read/Write) CD-ROM (Read/Write) Front Bezel Assembly EMC Shield for 5.25" Bay Blank Bezel 5.25" Bay Door Assembly Blank Door Bezel 1.44 MB, 3.5-Inch Diskette Drive 1.44 MB, 3.5-Inch Diskette Drive (Japan) Speaker with Cable Assembly Fan Assembly Hard Disk Mounting Bracket 10.1 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive (6574) 13.5 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive Order either of the below 20.4 GB hard drives 20.4 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 20.4 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive Order either of the below 27.2 GB hard drives 27.2 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive (6564) 27.2 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive (6564) 30 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive (6564) Hard Drive Rails (Qty 2) System Board - for 450/500/533/600B processors (no processor, no memory) System Board - for 533EB/600EB and higher processors (no processor, no memory) NVidia AGP4 32 MB Video Card Savage4 Video Card - 100 2xAGP Savage2 Video Card - 143 4xAGP Video Card 4xAGP Dongle S3 Diamond Video card Ethernet Adapter - Lake Clark 2.3 Ethernet Adapter - Accton Power Supply Bracket Power Supply-145W Power Supply-145W (China) Power Supply-145W (Japan) Fan Duct Pentium III 450/100 MHz. Pentium III 500/100 MHz. Pentium III 533/133 MHz. FRU No. 37L2499
36L8789
6 6 2
2 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 8 9 10 11 12 12
36L8719 09N0897 37L2505 20L3073 37L2508 37L2506 37L2507 75H9550 75H9552 01K4909 37L4526 37L2501 36L8681 36L8689
12 12
36L8628 37L5723
12 12 12 13 14 14
15 15 15 15 15 15 16 17 17 17 18 19 19 19
10K1291 09N5898 33L1618 09N3435 10K2940 30L5929 01N3003 37L2502 01K9870 36L8815 20L2314 37L2512 00N3878 00N3879 37L5708
223
Index 19 19 19 19 19 19 20 20 21
System (Type 6564, 6574) Pentium III 533EB MHz. Pentium III 600B/133 MHz Pentium III 600EB MHz Pentium III 667 MHz Pentium III 733 MHz Pentium III 800 MHz Memory - 64 MB SDRAM, Non-Parity Memory - 128 MB SDRAM, Non-Parity Base Frame Assembly Cable - CD-ROM Audio Cable - ATA-66 2 Drop Cable - Diskette Drive Cable - Hard Disk Cable, ATA Cable - Wake On Ring EMC Shield for System Board Foot (4) LED/Power Switch Assembly Lithium Battery Miscellaneous Hardware Kit Modem - ADSL (6564) Modem - Domestic (6564) Modem - Universal - EMEA and Asia Pacific South (6564) Mouse - 2 button (6574) Mouse - Scrollpoint (6564) Name Plate (6564, 6574) Power button (6564, 6574) URM retainer Kit
FRU No. 09N3464 01N2656 37L5710 01N2718 09N3466 10K2997 33L3072 33L3074 37L2500 75H9219 37L5098 01K1513 37L4525 76H7345 37L2504 03K9655 37L2511 33F8354 20L3094 00N4354 01N2833 01N2834 10L6145 28L1865 37L2510 10K1701 33L4521
224
225
226
7 9 8 10 16 15 14 13
21
20
18
19
17
227
12
11
Parts listing
Index 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 3 3 4 5 5 6 6 7 7 8 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 10 11 12 System (Type 2178, 2198) Top Cover Assembly Top Cover Assembly (2178-black) CD-ROM DRIVE - 48X CD-ROM (Read/Write) CD-ROM (Read/Write) (2178-black) CD-ROM (8x4x32 Read/Write) 8X DVD - Primary 8X DVD - optional 8X DVD (2178-black) 8X DVD Primary (2178-black) Front Bezel Assembly Front Bezel Assembly (2178-black) EMC Shield for 5.25" Bay Blank Bezel 5.25" Bay Blank Bezel 5.25" Bay (2178-black) Door Assembly Door Assembly (2178-black) Blank Door Bezel Blank Door Bezel (2178-black) 1.44 MB, 3.5-Inch Diskette Drive Speakers with Cable Assembly Speakers (2178-black) Speaker brick - Australia/New Zealand (2178) Speaker brick - Brazil (2178) Speaker brick - China (2178) Speaker brick - EMEA (2178) Speaker brick - GB/UK (2178) Speaker brick - Hong Kong (2178) Speaker brick - US/Taiwan/Canada Fan Assembly Hard Disk Mounting Bracket 15.0 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive Order either of the below 20.4 GB hard drives 20.4 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 20.4 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 30 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 40 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 45 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive Hard Drive Rails (Qty 2) System Board (no processor, no memory) System Board (2178 model 70P, 80P only) (no processor, no memory) Audio card - Creative Soundblaster (2198) Video card - NVidia NV10 VGA - 32 MB Video card - NVidia NV15 VGA - 32 MB (2198) Savage4 Video Card 2x AGP (2178) Video card - 4xAGP W/32MB w/TV out Dongle for 4xAGP video card Aureal Audio Adapter Askey modem - domestic Askey modem - universal (2178) GVC modem - domestic primary FRU No. 37L2499 09N1745 09N0735 09N0897 19K1509 09N0891 09N0749 09N0765 09N0767 09N0751 37L2505 09N1746 20L3073 37L2508 09N1749 37L2506 09N1747 37L2507 09N1748 75H9550 10K2601 10K2603 10K2595 10K2789 10K2597 10K2591 10K2589 19K2551 10K2587 37L4526 37L2501 09N0851
12 12 12 12 12 13 14 14 15 15 15 15 15 15 15 15 15
36L8628 37L5723 09N0925 09N0965 19K1569 01K1539 61H2541 61H2569 19K7990 19K2960 19K8168 09N5898 09N1708 09N3435 09N1661 09N1627 09N1626 09N1678
228
Index 15 15 16 17 17 18 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 20 20 21
System (Type 2178, 2198) GVC modem - universal primary (2178) Home PNA combo adapter Power Supply Bracket Power Supply-145W Power Supply-145W (China) (2178) Fan Duct Pentium III 533EB MHz. Pentium III 600EB MHz Pentium III 667 MHz Pentium III 733 MHz Pentium III 800 MHz Pentium III 866 MHz Pentium III 933 MHz Memory - 64 MB SDRAM, Non-Parity Memory - 128 MB SDRAM, Non-Parity Base Frame Assembly Ethernet card - Accton (2178) Cable - CD-ROM Audio Cable - ATA-66 2 Drop Cable - Diskette Drive Cable - Hard Disk Cable, ATA Cable - Midi game port Cable - Wake On Ring EMC Shield for System Board Foot (4) LED/Power Switch Assembly Lithium Battery Microphone Miscellaneous Hardware Kit Mouse - Scrollpoint Mouse - Scrollpoint (2178-black) Name Plate (2178/2198) Name Plate (2178-black) Power Button URM retainer Kit
FRU No. 09N1676 10K2029 37L2502 01K9870 36L8815 37L2512 09N3462 37L5710 01N2718 09N3466 10K2997 10K2958 19K8124 33L3072 33L3074 09N1788 01N3003 09N1782 37L5098 01K1513 37L4525 09N1786 76H7345 37L2504 03K9655 37L2511 33F8354 01N1851 20L3094 28L1865 28L1868 01N3057 09N1750 10K1701 33L4521
229
230
Display and Monitor Information Display and monitor information is separately available and is listed under Related publications on page v.
Special tools
The following tools are required to service these computers: A volt-ohm meter, IBM P/N 73G5404 Wrap Plug, IBM P/N 72X8546
231
232
PC 300 - 6565/6566
This section contains the general checkout procedures, additional service information, computer exploded view, Symptom-to-FRU indexes, undetermined problem, model tables, and parts listings for the IBM PC 300, type 6565/6566 computer. Note This manual and the diagnostic tests are intended to test only IBM products. Non-IBM products of any kind including adapter cards, accelerator boards, options, or non-IBM devices, can give false errors and invalid computer responses. If you remove a non-IBM device and the symptom goes away, the problem is with the device you removed. General checkout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Module test menu and hardware configuration report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-pin main power supply connection . . . . Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Diagnostics and test information . . . . . . . . Power-on self-test (POST) . . . . . . . . . POST beep codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . Error code format . . . . . . . . . . . . . IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics . . . . . . . Starting the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Navigating through the diagnostic programs . Running diagnostic tests . . . . . . . . . . Test selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IBM PC Enhanced Memory Diagnostics . . . Alert On LAN test . . . . . . . . . . . . . Asset ID test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Test results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hard file Smart test . . . . . . . . . . . . IBM Fixed Disk Optimized Test . . . . . . . Quick and Full erase - hard drive . . . . . . Iomega Zip Drive Test . . . . . . . . . . . Asset EEPROM backup . . . . . . . . . . Viewing the test log . . . . . . . . . . . . SIMM/DIMM memory errors . . . . . . . Setup Utility program . . . . . . . . . . . . Hard disk drive boot error . . . . . . . . . When to use the Low-Level Format program Preparing the hard disk drive for use . . . . Product description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Specifications Type 6565/6566 . . . . . . . Additional service information . . . . . . . . . Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 239 240 240 241 242 243 244 244 244 245 246 246 246 247 247 247 248 248 248 249 249 250 250 250 251 251 253 253 254 254 255 256 257
233
Replacing a processor . . . . . . . . . . . Replacing a system board . . . . . . . . . Security features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Passwords . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power-on password . . . . . . . . . . . Administrator password . . . . . . . . . Administrator password control . . . . . Operating system password . . . . . . . Vital product data . . . . . . . . . . . . . Management Information Format (MIF) . . . Alert on LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hard disk drive jumper settings . . . . . . . IDE hard disk drive settings . . . . . . . CD-ROM drive jumper settings . . . . . . . BIOS levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flash (BIOS/VPD) update procedure . . . . Flash recovery boot block . . . . . . . . . Power management . . . . . . . . . . . . Automatic configuration and power interface (ACPI) BIOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . Advanced Power Management . . . . . Automatic Hardware Power Management features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting Automatic Hardware Power Management features . . . . . . . . . Automatic Power-On features . . . . . . Enhanced Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . Network settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flash over LAN (update POST/BIOS over network) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Wake on LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System board memory . . . . . . . . . . . Computer exploded view (Type 6565/6566) . . . Input/Output connectors . . . . . . . . . . Cover removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front bezel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EMC shield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Diskette/hard drive bracket . . . . . . . . . CD-ROM drive removal . . . . . . . . . . Power supply removal . . . . . . . . . . . Optional pedestal . . . . . . . . . . . . . System board layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . System board locations . . . . . . . . . . System board switch settings . . . . . . . . Symptom-to-FRU index . . . . . . . . . . . . Beep symptoms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . No beep symptoms . . . . . . . . . . . . POST error codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . Miscellaneous error messages . . . . . . . Undetermined problem . . . . . . . . . . . . Model tables - Country/Region/Language . . . . Type/Model configuration tables (6565/6566) Parts (Type 6565/6566) . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
257 258 258 258 259 260 260 260 260 260 261 262 262 263 264 265 265 266 266 266 266 267 267 268 269 269 270 271 272 273 274 275 276 276 276 277 278 278 279 280 281 282 283 284 286 301 304 305 306 314
234
315 318
PC 300 - 6565/6566
235
General checkout
This general checkout procedure is for Type 6565/6566 computers. Attention The drives in the computer you are servicing might have been rearranged or the drive startup sequence changed. Be extremely careful during write operations such as copying, saving, or formatting. Data or programs can be overwritten if you select an incorrect drive. Diagnostic error messages appear when a test program finds a problem with a hardware option. For the test programs to properly determine if a test Passed, Failed, or Aborted, the test programs check the error-return code at test completion. See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics on page 246. General error messages appear if a problem or conflict is found by an application program, the operating system, or both. For an explanation of these messages, refer to the information supplied with that software package. Notes 1. Before replacing any FRUs, ensure the latest level of BIOS is installed on the system. A down-level BIOS might cause false errors and unnecessary replacement of the system board. For more information on how to determine and obtain the latest level BIOS, see BIOS levels on page 264. 2. If multiple error codes are displayed, diagnose the first error code displayed. 3. If the computer hangs with a POST error, go to Symptom-to-FRU index on page 282. 4. If the computer hangs and no error is displayed, go to Undetermined problem on page 304. 5. If an installed device is not recognized by the diagnostics program, that device might be defective. The power-on default is quick bring-up. To enable Enhanced bring-up, select the Start Options in the Configuration/Setup Utility program (see Setup Utility program on page 253) then, enable Power On Status. 001 Power-off the computer and all external devices. Check all cables and power cords. Make sure the system board is seated properly. Set all display controls to the middle position. (Step 001 continues)
236
001 (continued) Insert the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics diskette into drive A. Power-on all external devices. Power-on the computer. Check for the following response: 1. Readable instructions or the Main Menu. Note Type 6565/6566 computers default to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 253. DID YOU RECEIVE THE CORRECT RESPONSE? Yes No 002 If the Power Management feature is enabled, do the following: 1. Start the Configuration/Setup Utility program (see Setup Utility program on page 253) 2. Select Power Management from the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 3. Select APM 4. Be sure APM BIOS Mode is set to Disabled. If it is not, press Left Arrow ( ) or Right Arrow ( ) to change the setting. 5. Select Automatic Hardware Power Management. 6. Set Automatic Hardware Power Management to Disabled. or Go to the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics on page 246. 003 Run the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics test. If necessary, refer to Diagnostics and test information on page 244. If you receive an error, replace the part that the diagnostic program calls out or go to IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics on page 246. If the test stops and you cannot continue, replace the last device tested. If the computer has incorrect keyboard responses, go to Keyboard on page 240. (Step 003 continues)
PC 300 - 6565/6566
237
(CONTINUED)
003 (continued) If the printer has incorrect responses, go to Printer on page 240. If the display has problems such as jittering, rolling, shifting, or being out of focus, go to Display on page 243.
238
PC 300 - 6565/6566
239
Keyboard
Note If a mouse or other pointing device is attached, remove it to see if the error symptom goes away. If the symptom goes away, the mouse or pointing device is defective. 001 Power-off the computer. Disconnect the keyboard cable from the system unit. Power-on the computer and check the keyboard cable connector on the system unit for the voltages shown. All voltages are 5%.
Pin 1 2 3 4
5
6
6 4 2
5 3 1
ARE THE VOLTAGES CORRECT? Yes No 002 Replace the system board. 003 On keyboards with a detachable cable, replace the cable. If the problem remains or if the cable is permanently attached to the keyboard, replace the keyboard. If the problem remains, replace the system board.
Printer
1. Make sure the printer is properly connected and powered on. 2. Run the printer self-test. If the printer self-test does not run correctly, the problem is in the printer. Refer to the printer service manual. If the printer self-test runs correctly, install a wrap plug in the parallel port and run the diagnostic tests to determine which FRU failed. If the diagnostic tests (with the wrap plug installed) do not detect a failure, replace the printer cable. If that does not correct the problem, replace the system board or adapter connected to the printer cable.
240
Power supply
If the power-on indicator is not on, the power-supply fan is not running, or the computer will not power-off, do the following.
Check/Verify 1. Verify that the voltage-selector switch is set for the correct voltage. 2. Check the following for proper installation. Power Cord On/Off Switch connector On/Off Switch Power Supply connector System Board Power Supply connectors microprocessor(s) connection 3. Check the power cord for proper continuity. 4. Check the power-on switch for continuity. FRU/Action Correct the voltage-selector switch setting. Reseat
PC 300 - 6565/6566
241
11
20
Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
Signal 3.3 V 3.3 V COM 5V COM 5V COM POK 5VSB 12 V 3.3 V -12 V COM PS-ON COM COM COM not used 5V 5V
Function +3.3 V dc +3.3 V dc Ground +5 V dc Ground +5 V dc Ground Power Good Standby Voltage +12 V dc +3.3 V dc -12 V dc Ground DC Remote Enable Ground Ground Ground not used +5 V dc +5 V dc
If the voltages are not correct, and the power cord is good, replace the power supply.
242
Display
If the screen is rolling, replace the display assembly. If that does not correct the problem, replace the video adapter (if installed) or replace the system board. If the screen is not rolling, do the following to run the display self-test: 1. 2. 3. 4. Power-off the computer and display. Disconnect the display signal cable. Power-on the display. Turn the brightness and contrast controls clockwise to their maximum setting. 5. Check for the following conditions: You should be able to vary the screen intensity by adjusting the contrast and brightness controls. The screen should be white or light gray, with a black margin (test margin) on the screen. Note The location of the test margin varies with the type of display. The test margin might be on the top, bottom, or one or both sides. If you do not see any test margin on the screen, replace the display. If there is a test margin on the screen, replace the video adapter (if installed) or replace the system board. Note During the first two or three seconds after the display is powered on, the following might occur while the display synchronizes with the computer. Unusual patterns or characters Static, crackling, or clicking sounds A power-on hum on larger displays A noticeable odor might occur on new displays or displays recently removed from storage. These sounds, display patterns, and odors are normal; do not replace any parts. If you are unable to correct the problem, go to Undetermined problem on page 304.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
243
244
Note Type 6565/6566 computers default to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: 1. Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 253.
RDDDPLSCB QEET Test state Error code Extension Qualifier Bus ( =internal 1=external) Capacity of the device Slot number of the device LUN (usually ) PUN (SCSI ID #) Device Number Reserved Digit (usually )
PC 300 - 6565/6566
245
This diagnostic diskette includes: A new user interface (WaterGate Software's PC-Doctor) This interface serves as the control program for running both the IBM PC Enhanced Memory Diagnostics and the suite of diagnostic tests provided by PC-Doctor. IBM PC PC Enhanced Memory Diagnostics The memory diagnostic tests determine which memory module (SIMM or DIMM) is defective and report the socket where the failing module is located. The Memory diagnostics can run a quick and full test of the system. Diagnostics can also be run on a single SIMM or DIMM. Note See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnosticsfor the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics error codes.
246
Use the cursor movement keys to navigate within the menus. The Enter key is used to select a menu item. The Esc key is used to back up to the previous menu. For online help select F1.
Test selection
To select one or more tests: 1. Open the corresponding test category. 2. Using the cursor movement keys, highlight the desired test. 3. Press Space bar. A selected test is marked with a chevron, >>. Pressing the space bar again de-selects a test and removes the chevron. 4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 above to select all desired tests.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
247
1. Select the DIAGNOSTICS option on the toolbar and press Enter. 2. Highlight either the 'Memory Test-Full' or 'Memory Test-Quick option and press Enter. Memory Test-Full The full memory test will take about 80 seconds per MB of memory and will detect marginal, intermittent, and solid (stuck) memory failures. Memory Test-Quick The quick memory test will take about 20 seconds per MB of memory and will detect solid (stuck) memory failures only. Notes Either level of memory testing can be performed on all memory or a single SIMM/DIMM socket. Only sockets containing a SIMM or DIMM can be selected for testing. Unpopulated sockets are noted by ........ besides the test description.
Asset ID test
The Asset ID test does the following: Determines if Asset ID is supported on the system. Verifies the EEPROM areas. Performs an antenna detection test.
Test results
IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostic test results will produce this error code format:
Function Failure Code Type DeviceID Date ChkDigits Text
Represents the feature or function within the PC. Represents the type of error encountered. Contains the component's unit-id which corresponds to either a fixed disk drive, removable media drive, serial or parallel port, processor, specific DIMM, or a device on the PCI bus.
248
Date:
ChkDigits:
Text: Note
Contains the date on which the diagnostic test was run. Date is retrieved from CMOS and displayed using the YYYYMMDD format. Contains a 2-digit check-digit value to ensure that: Diagnostics were run on the specified date Diagnostics were run on the specified IBM computer The diagnostic error code is recorded correctly Description of the error.
See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics error codes on page 1 for error code listings.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
249
250
SIMM/DIMM memory errors: SIMM/DIMM error messages issued by the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics:
Message 2xx-1y Failure Found A memory error was detected in SIMM socket Y Recommended Actions Replace the SIMM in the socket identified by the last digit of the error code. Re-run the test. If the same error code occurs again, replace the system board. 2xx-2y A memory error was detected in DIMM socket Y Replace the DIMM in the socket identified by the last digit of the error code. Re-run the test. If the same error code occurs again, replace the system board or where memory is on the processor card, replace the processor card. Corrupt BIOS Information in BIOS is not as expected. Not able to find expected DMI information from BIOS. Memory controller chipset vendor ID does not match expected value. Reflash the BIOS. Perform boot block recovery. Replace the system board.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
251
"Y" is the SIMM/DIMM socket number. Use the System Board Layouts section in the latest PC 300/700, IntelliStation Hardware Maintenance Manual, HMM, to reference the memory sockets.
252
PC 300 - 6565/6566
253
Actions The drive must be formatted, do the following: 1. Attempt to access and recover (back-up) the failing hard disk drive. 2. Using the operating systems programs, format the hard disk drive. 3. Go to Preparing the hard disk drive for use on page 254.
254
Product description
The PC 300 Type 6565/6566 computer is available in 4 x 4, (Four drive bays, four I/O adapter slots, including an AGP socket) as desktop models. Security Administrator password Cover lock Power-on password Operating system password C2 security U-bolt and cable (Optional for some models)
CMOS backup battery (lithium) Common parts (Varies with each model, see Type/Model configuration tables (6565/6566) on page 306.) Diskette drive Hard disk drive Keyboard Power supply Mouse
Specifications Information (ISO/ANSI) The model specifications information on the following pages was determined in controlled acoustical environments according to procedures specified by the American National Standards Institute (ANSI) S12.10 and ISO 7779, and are reported in accordance with ISO 9296. Actual sound pressure levels in your location might differ from the average values stated because of room reflections and other nearby noise sources. The declared sound power levels indicate an upper limit, below which a large proportion of machines will operate.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
255
Weight Environment
Heat Output
Electrical Input
256
Replacing a processor
Make sure the processor is fully seated in its socket and that the goal post latches are engaged. Important Make sure the air baffle is installed to prevent processor overheating. If the processor is not installed correctly, the system board and the processor can be damaged.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
257
Security features
Security features in this section include: Passwords Vital Product Data Management Information Format (MIF) Alert on LAN
Passwords
The following provides information about computer hardware and software-related passwords: Power-on Password Administrator Password Operating System Password Power-on and Administrator passwords are set in the Setup Utility program. See Setup Utility program on page 253 for information about running the Setup Utility.
258
Power-on password: A power-on password denies access to the computer by an unauthorized user when the computer is powered on. When a power-on password is active, the password prompt appears on the screen each time the computer is powered on. The computer starts after the proper password is entered.
Removing a power-on password To service a computer with an active and unknown power-on password, power-off the computer and do the following: Attention If Enhanced Security is not enabled, this procedure will remove the administrator password, all setup and boot sequence settings and privilege access. Make sure these settings are recorded before you perform this procedure. If Enhanced Security is enabled, Only Enhanced Security functions like boot sequence and privilege access will not be changed. Other settings will be cleared 1. Unplug the power cord and remove the top cover. 2. Refer to System board layout on page 279 to find the CMOS switch. 3. Move the CMOS switch to the on position. 4. Power-on the computer. The system senses the change in the position and erases the password. It is necessary to move the CMOS switch to the off position. 5. Remind the user to enter a new password when service is complete.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
259
Administrator password: The administrator password is used to restrict access to the Configuration/Setup Utility program. If the administrator password is activated, and you do not enter the administrator password, the configuration can be viewed but not changed.
Note Type 6565/6566 have Enhanced Security Mode. If Enhanced Security mode is enabled and there is no password given, the computer will act as if Enhanced Security is disabled. If Enhanced Security is Enabled and an administrator password is given, the administrator password must be entered to use the computer. If the administrator password is lost or forgotten, the system board in the computer must be replaced in order to regain access to the Configuration/Setup Utility program.
Administrator password control The Administrator password is set in the Setup Configuration. Refer to Setup Utility program on page 253 Operating system password: An operating system password is very similar to a power-on password and denies access to the computer by an unauthorized user when the password is activated. The computer is unusable until the password is entered and recognized by the computer.
260
The customer has the option to purchase serial number information and services from Retain-a-Group. It is the customer's responsibility to maintain the MIF file and to inform Retain-a-Group of any changes to the file. Some customers may request their servicers to assist them in maintaining the MIF file when serialized components are replaced during hardware service. This assistance is between the customer and the servicer. The servicer can use the DMI MIF Browser to update the MIF information in the EPROM. It is anticipated that some servicers might charge for this service. To update the EPROM using the DMI MIF Browser: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Click Start from the desktop, then Programs. Select IBM SystemView Agent. Select Serial Number Information icon. Click the plus sign to expand. Select the component you want to view or edit. Double click on the component you want to change. Enter new data in the Value field, then click Apply.
Alert on LAN
Alert on LAN provides notification of changes in the computer, even when the computer power is turned off. Working with DMI and Wake on LAN technologies, Alert on LAN helps to manage and monitor the hardware and software features of the computer. Alert on LAN generates notifications to the server of these occurrences: Computer disconnected from the network Computer unplugged from the power outlet All POST errors Operating system or POST hang condition Alert on LAN events are configured to be Enabled or Disabled from the LAN server only, and not from the computer. See the LAN administrator for configuration status information.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
261
IDE Drives
262
AUDIO
RGGL
39 40
IDE INTERFACE
1 2
DC INPUT
5V G G 12V
CD-ROM, PD/CD-ROM Type 2X CD-ROM FRU 06H5906 4X CD-ROM FRU 06H7654 6X CD-ROM 8X CD-ROM 6X PD/CD-ROM 16X Max CD-ROM 24X Max CD-ROM 32X Max CD-ROM 40X Max CD-ROM 48X Max CD-ROM
Primary (Master) : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : :
Secondary (Slave) : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : :
PC 300 - 6565/6566
263
BIOS levels
An incorrect level of BIOS can cause false error and unnecessary FRU replacement. Use the following information to determine the current level of BIOS installed in the computer, the latest BIOS available for the computer, and where to obtain the latest level of BIOS. Current Level BIOS information. Run the Configuration Utility to determine the level of BIOS installed. Sources for determining the latest level BIOS available. 1. IBM PC Company Home Page http://www.ibm.com/pc/us/ 2. PC PartnerInfo-Technical Database (CTSTIPS.NSF) 3. HelpCenter 4. Levels 1 and 2 Support 5. RETAIN Sources for obtaining the latest level BIOS available. 1. IBM PC Company Home Page http://www.ibm.com/pc/us/ 2. PC PartnerInfo-Technical Database (CTSTIPS.NSF) 3. HelpCenter 4. Levels 1 and 2 Support To update (flash) the BIOS, see Flash (BIOS/VPD) update procedure on page 265.
264
PC 300 - 6565/6566
265
Power management
Power management reduces the power consumption of certain components of the computer such as the system power supply, processor, hard disk drives, and some monitors. Advanced Power Management and Rapid Resume Manager are features of some personal computers.
Automatic configuration and power interface (ACPI) BIOS: Being an ACPI BIOS
system, the operating system is allowed to control the power management features of the computer and the setting for Advanced Power Management (APM) BIOS mode are ignored. Not all operating systems support ACPI BIOS mode.
Energy-saving settings can be viewed and changed by using the Advanced Power Management menu in the Configuration/Setup Utility program. Attention If a device, such as a monitor, does not have power-management capabilities, it can be damaged when exposed to a reduced-power state. Before making energy-saving selections for the monitor, check the documentation supplied with the monitor to see if it supports Display Power Management Signaling (DPMS).
At each level, you can define the amount of energy savings by specifying values for the following options: System Power: Select On for the computer to remain on. Select Off for the computer to shut down. Processor Speed:
266
Set the microprocessor to be disabled, or to run at 1, 10, 25, or 50 percent of its internal clock speed. Display: Set display to be disabled or to be reduced at these power states: Standby: Screen is blank, but can be restored immediately when any activity is detected. Suspend: Monitor uses less power than in Standby mode. Screen image is restored after a few seconds when any activity is detected. Off: Monitor power is off. Press Monitor power button to restore power. On some monitors, you might have to depress the power button twice.
The Automatic Power-On features within the Advanced Power Management menu allow you to enable and disable features that turn the computer on automatically. Serial Port Ring Detect: With this feature set to Enabled and an external modem connected to serial port (COM1), the computer will turn on automatically when a ring is detected on the modem.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
267
Modem Ring Detect: With this feature set to Enabled, the computer will turn on automatically when a ring is detected on the internal modem. Wake Up on Alarm: You can specify a date and time at which the computer will be turned on automatically. This can be either a single event or a daily event. Wake on LAN: If the computer has a properly configured token-ring or Ethernet LAN adapter card that is Wake on LAN-enabled and there is remote network management software, you can use the IBM-developed Wake on LAN feature. When you set Wake on LAN to Enabled, the computer will turn on when it receives a specific signal from another computer on the local area network (LAN). For further information, see Wake on LAN on page 270.
Enhanced Security
Note Type 6565/6566 have Enhanced Security Mode. If Enhanced Security mode is enabled and there is no password given, the computer will act as if Enhanced Security is disabled. If Enhanced Security is Enabled and an administrator password is given, the administrator password must be entered to use the computer. If the administrator password is lost or forgotten, the system board in the computer must be replaced in order to regain access to the Configuration/Setup Utility program. Enhanced Security is an additional security feature available on type 6565/6566. Enhanced Security can be enabled or disabled only when you update system programs. If Enhanced Security is enabled and the administrator password has not been set, the computer will operate as if Enhanced Security is disabled. If Enhanced Security is enabled and the administrator password has been set, the computer has these additional security measures: The contents of the security EEPROM (the administrator password and startup sequence) are protected if the battery or CMOS memory fails. The security EEPROM is protected from unauthorized access. The security EEPROM cannot be read from or written to by any software application or system software until Enhanced Security is disabled and the computer is restarted. In a network environment, this might prevent certain functions from being performed on the computer.
268
Remote Administration is locked and cannot be unlocked until Enhanced Security is disabled and the computer is restarted. This prevents the system programs in the computer from being updated remotely. The configuration settings in the Configuration/Setup Utility program are protected and cannot be changed until the administrator password has been entered. Any changes in computer hardware detected by the system programs in the computer will generate a configuration error until the administrator password has been entered. To enable or disable Enhanced Security: 1. Insert a system programs update diskette into the diskette drive (drive A). System programs updates are available at http://www.ibm.com/pc/support/us/ on the World Wide Web. 2. Power-on the computer. If it is powered on, you must power-off then power-on. 3. The update begins, the computer halts, and you are prompted for the administrator password (if you have set an administrator password). The computer remains in a halted state until the administrator password is entered. 4. When the administrator password is entered, or if no administrator password has been set, the update diskette will continue to run, and you are given the option of enabling or disabling Enhanced Security. The choice is automatically recorded in the System Security menu of the Configuration/Setup Utility program.
Network settings
This section applies only to computers linked to a network. The Configuration/Setup Utility program includes settings that can be enabled and disabled to configure the network interface in the computer. These settings are: Flash over LAN (Update POST/BIOS over Network) Wake on LAN
PC 300 - 6565/6566
269
To access the Flash over LAN setting: 1. Start the Configuration/Setup Utility program. See Setup Utility program on page 253. 2. Select System Security. 3. Select POST/BIOS Update from the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 4. To enable Flash over LAN, select Enabled. To disable Flash over LAN, select Disabled. 5. Press Esc twice to return to the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 6. Before you exit from the program, select Save Settings from the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 7. To exit from the Configuration/Setup Utility program, press Esc and follow the instructions on the screen.
Wake on LAN
This setting is used to enable or disable the IBM-developed Wake on LAN feature. This feature makes it possible for the computer to be turned on remotely by a network server. Remote network management software must be used in conjunction with this feature. To access the Wake on LAN setting: 1. Start the Configuration/Setup Utility program. See Setup Utility program on page 253. 2. Select Advanced Power Management. 3. Select Automatic Power On from the program menu. 4. Select Wake on LAN from the Automatic Power On menu. 5. To enable Wake on LAN, select Enabled. To disable Wake on LAN, select Disabled. 6. Press Esc until you return to the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 7. Before you exit from the program, select Save Settings from the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 8. To exit from the Configuration/Setup Utility program, press Esc and follow the instructions on the screen.
270
Supported memory configuration DIMM sizes of 64 MB, 128 MB, and 256 MB ECC or 64 MB, 128 MB, and 256 MB, and 512 MB Non-ECC are acceptable. Start filling DIMM socket 0, then 1. Use 3.3 V unbuffered 133 MHz. SDRAM DIMMs only.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
271
I/O connectors and removal procedures for the cover, front panel, front bezel, EMC shield, diskette/hard drive bracket, CD-ROM drive, power supply, and optional pedestal are on the following pages.
272
Input/Output connectors
Serial 2
Parallel
DVI Monitor
2 1
2 1
Serial 1
USB 1
PC 300 - 6565/6566
273
Cover removal
To remove top cover: 1. Remove the three cover thumb screws. 2. Slide cover toward the rear of the chassis about 1-Inch (2 cm) to clear the front panel. 3. Lift cover up. To install top cover: 1. Slide cover down onto the chassis about 1-inch (2 cm) from the front panel. 2. Make sure bottom cover slots are engaged on the chassis. 3. Slide cover forward to engage the front cover slots onto the chassis. 4. Install the three cover thumb screws.
274
Front panel
To remove the front panel: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Release the three top latches while gently pulling the top of the panel outward. 3. Keeping the panel at the same angle, gently pull the panel out from the bottom of the chassis. To install the front panel: 1. At the same angle that the panel was when removed, install the bottom tabs of the panel in the chassis. Push up on the left and right bottom tabs, if necessary, to get the tabs in the holes of the chassis. 2. Push the top of the panel toward the chassis until the three top latches lock in place.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
275
Front bezel
To remove the front blank bezel: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Remove the front panel. 3. Unlatch the tabs of the bezel and remove it from the panel.
EMC shield
To remove the diskette/hard drive bracket: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Remove the diskette and hard drive cables. 3. Remove the two top screws securing the bracket. 4. Slide bracket toward the back of the chassis to unlatch it from the chassis. 5. Lift the bracket out of the chassis.
276
To remove the CD-ROM drive: 1. Remove the top cover. 2. Remove the cables from the CD-ROM drive. 3. Remove two screws securing the CD-ROM drive. 4. Pull the CD-ROM drive out of the chassis. Note When connecting the CD-ROM Audio Cable, make sure the cable is routed along the system board near the PCI adapter slots. Continue routing the cable along the system board between the power connector and primary IDE connector and then up to the CD-ROM drive. Do not route the CD-ROM cable near the system board I/O connectors.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
277
Optional pedestal
To remove the optional pedestal: 1. Lay the computer on its side where the pedestal is overhanging the edge of a table or desk. 2. Pull out on the plastic tab underneath the pedestal and move the pedestal toward the tab end, then, pull the pedestal away from the cover.
278
OFF
12345678
PC 300 - 6565/6566
OFF
1234
279
280
Clear CMOS Switch (SW1-2) Note The Clear CMOS switch (SW1-2) is also used to reset passwords.
Clear CMOS Normal mode CMOS clear SW1-2 Off (D) On
Processor Speed Settings Processor speed for the PC 300 type 6565 computer is fixed and is determined by the processor. There are no settings required.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
281
Symptom-to-FRU index
The Symptom-to-FRU index lists error symptoms and possible causes. The most likely cause is listed first. Always begin with General checkout on page 236. See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics error codes on page 1 when running diagnostics. This index can also be used to help you decide which FRUs to have available when servicing a computer. If you are unable to correct the problem using this index, go to Undetermined problem on page 304. Notes If you have both an error message and an incorrect audio response, diagnose the error message first. If you cannot run the diagnostic tests or you get a diagnostic error code when running a test, but did receive a POST error message, diagnose the POST error message first. If you did not receive any error message, look for a description of your error symptoms in the first part of this index. Check all power supply voltages before you replace the system board. (See Power supply on page 241.) Check the hard disk drive jumper settings before you replace a hard disk drive. (See Hard disk drive jumper settings on page 262.) Important 1. Some errors are indicated with a series of beep codes. (See Beep symptoms on page 283.) Type 6565/6566 computer defaults to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 253. 2. The processor is a separate FRU from the system board; the processor is not included with the system board FRU.
282
Beep symptoms
Beep symptoms are short tones or a series of short tones separated by pauses (intervals without sound). See the following examples.
Beeps 1-2-X Description One Beep A pause (or break) Two beeps A pause (or break) Any number of beeps Four continuous beeps FRU/Action 1. Run Setup 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Keyboard 2. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Run Setup 2. System Board 2-1-X First 64 KB of RAM failed. 2-2-2 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Run Setup 2. Memory Module 3. System Board 1. System Board 1. System Board 2. Keyboard 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 3. Display
4 Beep Symptom 1-1-3 CMOS read/write error 1-1-4 ROM BIOS check error 1-2-X DMA error 1-3-X 1-4-4 1-4-X Error detected in first 64 KB of RAM. 2-1-1, 2-1-2
3-1-X DMA register failed. 3-2-4 Keyboard controller failed. 3-3-4 Screen initialization failed.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
283
Beep Symptom 3-4-1 Screen retrace test detected an error. 3-4-2 POST is searching for video ROM. 4
FRU/Action 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 3. Display 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board
All other beep code sequences. One long and one short beep during POST. Base 640 KB memory error or shadow RAM error. One long beep and two or three short beeps during POST. (Video error) Three short beeps during POST.
1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. See System board memory on page 271. 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. Keyboard stuck key? 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board
No beep symptoms
Note Type 6565/6566 computer defaults to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 253.
Symptom/Error No beep during POST but computer works correctly. FRU/Action 1. System Board
284
FRU/Action 1. See Undetermined problem on page 304. 2. System Board 3. Memory Module 4. Any Adapter or Device 5. Power Cord 6. Power Supply
PC 300 - 6565/6566
285
02X 08X Check SCSI terminator installation. 101 System board interrupt failure. 102 System board timer error. 106 110 System board memory parity error. 111 I/O channel parity error. 114 Adapter ROM error. 129 Internal cache test error. 151 Real-time clock failure. 161 Bad CMOS battery.
1. System Board
1. System Board 1. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Reseat adapters 2. Any Adapter 3. System Board 1. Adapter Memory 2. System Board 1. Processor 2. L2 Cache Memory 3. System Board 1. System Board 1. Run Setup 2. CMOS Backup Battery (See page Safety information on page 434.) 3. System Board
286
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup and verify Configuration 2. Had a device been added, removed, changed location? If not, suspect that device. 3. Power-on external devices first, then power-on computer. 4. CMOS Backup Battery (See page Safety information on page 434.) 5. System Board 1. Diskette Drive 2. System Board 3. Diskette Drive Cable 1. Time and Date Set? 2. CMOS Backup Battery (See page Safety information on page 434.) 3. System Board 1. Run Setup. Check System Summary menu for memory size change. (See Setup Utility program on page 253.) 2. Run the Extended Memory Diagnostic tests. 1. Run Flash Recovery using Boot Block. See Flash recovery boot block on page 265 2. System Board 1. Run Setup. Check Stepping level for the BIOS level needed, then perform the flash update. 2. Processor 1. Run Setup. Check to see that Ethernet and Alert on LAN are enabled. 2. System Board 1. C2 Security
162 And unable to run diagnostics. 163 Clock not updating or invalid time set.
164 POST detected a base memory or extended memory size mismatch error.
17X, 18X
PC 300 - 6565/6566
287
FRU/Action 1. Run Configuration (See Setup Utility program on page 253.) 2. System Board 1. Covers were removed from the computer. 1. System Board
1. System Board 1. Enter the administrator password 1. Make sure Asset Care and Asset ID are enabled in Configuration/Setup. 2. RFID Antenna 3. System Board 1. Set configuration and reinstall the boot sequence. 1. System Board 1. Clear Administration password 2. System Board 1. More than three password attempts were made to access the computer. 1. System Board
189
190 Chassis intrusion detector was cleared. This is information only, no action required. If this code does not clear: 1XX Not listed above. 201, 20X Memory data error.
1. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diag. Memory Test 2. Memory Module 3. System Board 1. Unsupported Memory 1. L2 Cache Memory 2. System Board
288
POST Error Code 262 POST detected a base memory or extended memory type error.
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup. Check System Summary menu for memory type change. (See Setup Utility program on page 253.) 2. Run the Extended Memory Diagnostic tests. 1. Keyboard 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board 1. 2. 3. 4. Mouse Keyboard Keyboard Cable System Board
301
1. Keyboard 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board 1. Keyboard 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board
601
1. Diskette Drive A 2. Diskette Drive Cable 3. System Board 1. Bad Diskette ? 2. Verify Diskette and retry. 1. Run Setup and verify diskette configuration settings 2. Diskette Drive A/B 3. Diskette Drive Cable 4. System Board 1. Diskette Drive 2. Diskette Drive Cable 3. System Board 1. Diskette drive configuration error or wrong diskette drive type, run Setup Configuration. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Diskette Drive System Board External Drive Adapter Diskette Drive Cable Power Supply
602
PC 300 - 6565/6566
289
POST Error Code 762 Math coprocessor configuration error. 7XX Not listed above. 962 Parallel port configuration error. 9XX 1047 107X Check SCSI terminator installation.
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup 2. Processor 3. System Board 1. Processor 2. System Board 1. Run Configuration 2. Parallel Adapter (if installed) 3. System Board 1. Printer 2. System Board 1. 16-Bit AT Fast SCSI Adapter 1. Check SCSI terminator installation. 2. SCSI Cable 3. SCSI Terminator 4. SCSI Device 5. SCSI Adapter 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics
1101 Serial connector error, possible system board failure. 1101, 1102, 1106, 1108, 1109 1107
1. System Board 2. Any Serial Device 1. Communications Cable 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. System Board 1. Serial Device Cable 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Configuration 2. Serial Adapter (if installed) 3. System Board
1102 Card selected feedback error. 1103 Port fails register check. 1106 Serial option cannot be turned off. 1107 1110 Register test failed. 1116 Interrupt error. 1117 Failed baud rate test. 1162 Serial port configuration error.
290
POST Error Code 11XX Not listed above. 1201 1202, 1206, 1208, 1209, 12XX
FRU/Action 1. System Board 1. System Board 2. Any Serial Device 1. Dual Async Adapter/A 2. System Board 3. Any Serial Device 1. Communications Cable 2. Dual Async Adapter/A 1. Game Adapter Information only Information only
1207
13XX 1402 Printer not ready. 1403 No paper error, or interrupt failure. 1404 System board timeout failure. 1405 Parallel adapter error. 1406 Presence test error. 14XX Not listed above. Check printer before replacing system board. 15XX 1692 Boot sequence error. 16XX 1762 Hard disk drive configuration error. 1780 1781 1782 1783 (Disk (Disk (Disk (Disk Drive Drive Drive Drive 0) 1) 2) 3)
1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Printer 2. System Board
1. SDLC Adapter 1. Run FDISK to ensure at least one active partition is set active. 1. 36/38 Workstation Adapter 1. Run Configuration (See Setup Utility program on page 253.) 1. See Power supply on page 241. 2. Hard Disk Drive 3. System Board 4. Hard Disk Cable 5. Power Supply
PC 300 - 6565/6566
291
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup and verify PCI/ISA configuration settings. 2. If necessary, set ISA adapters to Not available to allow PCI adapters to properly configure. 3. Remove any suspect ISA adapters. 4. Rerun diagnostics. 5. PCI Adapter 1. Possible hard disk drive problem, see Hard disk drive boot error on page 253. 1. Diskette Drive 2. Diskette Cable 3. 16-bit AT Fast SCSI Adapter 1. BSC Adapter 1. SCSI Device 2. 16-bit AT Fast SCSI Adapter 3. Alternate BSC Adapter 1. Display 1. System Board 2. Display 1. Display 1. System Board 2. Display 1. Check cable connections. 2. Run Setup and verify video configuration settings. 3. Video Memory Modules 4. Video Adapter (if installed) 5. System Board 1. 2. 3. 4. Network Attached? LF Translator Cable Problem PC Network Adapter
209X
2401, 2402 If screen colors change. 2401, 2402 If screen colors are OK. 2409 2410 2462 Video memory configuration error.
3015, 3040 Check for missing wrap or terminator plug on the adapter. 30XX
292
FRU/Action 1. Network Attached? 2. LF Translator 3. Alternate PC Network-Adapter 4. Cable Problem 1. Alternate PC Network Adapter 2. LF Translator 3. Cable Problem 1. GPIB Adapter 1. DAC Adapter 1. Multiport/2 Interface Board 2. Multiport/2 Adapter 1. Memory Module Package 2. Multiport/2 Adapter 1. Multiport Interface Cable 1. Multiport/2 Adapter 2. Multiport/2 Interface Board 3. Memory Module 1. Financial System Controller Adapter 1. 2. 3. 4. Run Configuration CD-ROM Drive CD-ROM Adapter ZIP or other ATAPI device 5. System Board 1. 1st Store Loop Adapter 2. Adapter Cable 1. 2nd Store Loop Adapter 2. Adapter Cable 1. Network Adapter 1. Voice Adapter 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 1. Page Printer Adapter 1. High Speed Adapter 1. 3117 Adapter 1. PCMCIA Adapter 1. Speech Adapter 2. Speech Control Assy. 1. Pointing Device (Mouse) 2. System Board
31XX
5600 5962 An IDE device (other than hard drive) configuration error.
62XX
63XX
64XX 71XX 74XX 76XX 78XX 79XX 80XX 84XX 8601, 8602
PC 300 - 6565/6566
293
FRU/Action 1. System Board 2. Pointing Device (Mouse) 1. Mouse 2. System Board 1. PC Music Adapter 2. MIDI Adapter Unit 1. Optical Drive 2. Adapter 1. SCSI Adapter 2. Any SCSI Device 3. System Board
1. Have customer verify correct operating system device drivers are installed and operational. 2. Modem 1. System Board 2. Data/Fax Modem 1. Check system speaker 2. Check PSTN cable 3. External DAA (if installed) 4. Modem 1. Run Diagnostics and verify the correct operation of the modem slot 2. Modem 1. Diagnostics detected a non-IBM modem 2. Modem 1. Check PSTN Cable 2. External DAA (if installed) 3. Modem
10118
10119
10120
1. Modem
1. Data/Fax Modem 2. System Board 1. Modem Adapter/A 2. Data/Fax Modem 3. System Board
294
POST Error Code 10450, 10451, 10490 10491, 10492, 10499 Read/write error. 10452 Seek test error. 10453 Wrong drive type? 10454 Sector buffer test error. 10455, 10456 Controller error. 10459 Drive diagnostic command error. 10461 Drive format error 10462 Controller seek error. 10464 Hard Drive read error. 10467 Drive non fatal seek error. 10468 Drive fatal seek error. 10469 Drive soft error count exceeded. 10470, 10471, 10472 Controller wrap error. 10473 Corrupt data. Low level format might be required. 10480
FRU/Action 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. Hard Disk Drive 3. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics Information only 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics Information only
1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics Information only
1. Hard Disk Drive (ESDI) 2. Drive Cable 3. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Check Configuration 2. Ethernet Adapter 1. Power-off computer, wait ten seconds; then power-on the computer. 2. Ethernet Adapter
10481 ESDI drive D seek error. 10482 Drive select acknowledgement bad. 106X1 10635
PC 300 - 6565/6566
295
POST Error Code 10651, 10660 106XX Not listed above. 107XX
FRU/Action 1. Check Cables 2. Ethernet Adapter 1. Ethernet Adapter 1. 5.25-inch External Diskette Drive 2. 5.25-inch Diskette Drive Adapter/A 1. ActionMedia Adapter/A 2. System Board 1. SCSI Adapter 2. Any SCSI Device 3. System Board 1. 3119 Adapter 1. Modem Adapter 2. Any Serial Device 3. System Board 1. ISDN Primary Rate Adapter 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. Realtime Interface Coprocessor Portmaster Adapter/A 1. Japanese Display Adapter 2. System Board 1. System Board Video Adapter 2. Adapter Video Memory 1. Video Adapter 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 3. Display (any type) 1. External Display 2. Video Adapter 1. FaxConcentrator Adapter 1. 120 MB Internal Tape Drive 2. Diskette Cable 3. System Board 1. 6157 Tape Attachment Adapter 1. 6157 Streaming Tape Drive 2. 6157 Tape Attachment Adapter
109XX Check the adapter cables. 112XX This adapter does not have cache. 119XX 121XX
136XX
137XX 141XX
143XX
14710, 14711
296
FRU/Action 1. Token Ring Adapter 2. System Board 1. Wizard Adapter 2. Wizard Adapter Memory 1. Wizard Adapter Cable 1. DBCS Japanese Display Adapter/A 2. System Board 1. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 2. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 2. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 1. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 2. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 2. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 3. System Board 1. Printer/Scanner Option 2. Image Adapter/A 3. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 2. Printer/Scanner Option 3. Image Adapter/A 1. Printer/Scanner Option 2. Image Adapter/A 3. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Replace memory module (shown in graphic.) 1. SCSI-2 Adapter 2. Any SCSI Device 3. System Board 1. Any SCSI Device
20001 to 20003
20004
20005 to 20010
20101 to 20103
20104
20105 to 20110
208XX Verify there are no duplicate SCSI ID settings on the same bus.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
297
POST Error Code 210XXXX Internal bus, size unknown. 210XXX1 External bus, size unknown.
FRU/Action 1. SCSI Hard Disk Drive 2. SCSI Adapter or System Board 3. SCSI Cable 4. SCSI ID Switch (on some models) 1. Tape Drive 2. SCSI Cable (internal) 3. SCSI Adapter or System Board 1. Tape Drive 2. SCSI Adapter or System Board 3. SCSI Cable (internal) SCSI Cable (external) 1. Tape Cassette 2. Drive 1. Rotary Switch Circuit Board 2. Circuit Board Cable 3. Tape Drive
Tape automatically ejected from drive. SCSI ID on rotary switch does not match SCSI ID set in configuration. Verify drive switches inside cover are set to zero. Tape sticks/breaks in drive. Verify that the tapes used meet ANSI standard X3B5. 212XX 213XX 214XX 215XXXC 215XXXD 215XXXE 215XXXU If an external device, and power-on LED is off, check external voltages. 216XX 217XX If an external device, and power-on LED is off, check external voltages. 218XX Check for multi CD tray, or juke box. 219XX
1. Tape Cassette
1. SCSI Printer 2. Printer Cable 1. SCSI Processor 1. WORM Drive 1. CD-ROM Drive I CD-ROM Drive II Enhanced CD-ROM Drive II Any CD-ROM Drive 2. SCSI Cable 3. SCSI Adapter or System Board 1. Scanner 1. Rewritable Optical Drive 2. SCSI Adapter or System Board 3. SCSI Cable 1. Changer
298
FRU/Action 1. ISDN/2 Adapter 2. ISDN/2 Wrap Plug 3. ISDN/2 Communications Cable 1. 1 Mbps Micro Channel Infrared LAN Adapter 1. ServerGuard Adapter 2. System Board 1. ServerGuard Adapter
273XX
27501, 27503 27506, 27507 27502, 27504, 27510 27511, 27533, 27534 27536, 27537 27509
1. Remove redundant adapters, run Auto Configuration program, then retest. 1. WMSELF.DGS diagnostics file missing. 2. WMSELF.DGS diagnostics file incorrect. 1. 3V Lithium Backup Battery 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. Internal Temperature out of range 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. ServerGuard Adapter 2. Power Supply 1. 7.2V NiCad Main Battery Pack 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. PCMCIA Type II Modem 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. External Power Control not connected 2. External Power Control 3. ServerGuard Adapter 1. External Power Control 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. Update Diagnostic Software 1. Personal Dictation System Adapter 2. System Board 1. External FRU (Speaker, Microphone)
27512
27535
27554
27563, 27564
27880 to 27889
PC 300 - 6565/6566
299
FRU/Action Possible hard disk drive problem, see Hard disk drive boot error on page 253.
300
Changing colors. Computer will not power-off. See Power supply on page 241. Computer will not RPL from server
Dead computer. See Power supply on page 241. Diskette drive in-use light remains on or does not light when drive is active. Flashing cursor with an otherwise blank display.
PC 300 - 6565/6566
301
Message/Symptom Insert a Diskette icon appears with a known-good diagnostics diskette in the first 3.5-inch diskette drive. Intensity or color varies from left to right of characters and color bars. No power, or fan not running. Nonsystem disk or disk error-type message with a known-good diagnostic diskette. Other display symptoms not listed above (including blank or illegible display). Power-on indicator or hard disk drive in-use light not on, but computer works correctly. Printer problems. Program loads from the hard disk with a known-good diagnostics diskette in the first 3.5-inch diskette drive. RPL computer cannot access programs from its own hard disk.
FRU/Action 1. 2. 3. 4. Diskette Drive System Board Diskette Drive Cable Network Adapter
1. Display 2. System Board 1. See Power supply on page 241. 1. Diskette Drive 2. System Board 3. Diskette Drive Cable 1. See Display on page 243. 2. System Board 3. Display 1. Power Supply 2. System Board 3. LED Cables 1. See Printer on page 240. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Run Setup Diskette Drive Diskette Drive Cable System Board Power Supply
1. If network admin. is using LCCM Hybrid RPL, check startup sequence: First device: network; Second device: hard disk 2. Hard disk drive 1. Check startup sequence 2. Check the network adapter LED status 1. External Device Self-Test OK? 2. External Device 3. Cable 4. System Board 1. External Device Self-Test OK? 2. External Device 3. Cable 4. Alternate Adapter 5. System Board
302
PC 300 - 6565/6566
303
Undetermined problem
Check the power supply voltages. See Power supply on page 241. If the voltages are correct, return here and continue with the following steps. 1. Power-off the computer. 2. Remove or disconnect the following, if installed, one at a time: a. Non-IBM devices b. External devices (modem, printer, or mouse) c. Any adapters d. Memory modules Before removing or replacing memory modules, see System board memory on page 271. e. Extended video memory f. External Cache g. External Cache RAM h. Hard disk drive i. Diskette drive 3. Power-on the computer to re-test the system. 4. Repeat steps 1 through 3 until you find the failing device or adapter. If all devices and adapters have been removed, and the problem continues, replace the system board. See Replacing a system board on page 258.
304
Asia Pacific (AP) AP English w/Keyboard AP English w/o Keyboard Japan (Japanese) Hong Kong (AP English) Hong Kong (Chinese) China (Chinese) China (AP English) Thailand (Thai) Taiwan (Chinese) Taiwan (AP English) Korea (Korean) Korea (AP English)
Model xxA xxB xxJ xxH xxM xxC xxD xxT xxV xxW xxK xxR
PC 300 - 6565/6566
305
Page 307
306
Model
Processor
500 MHz
41X
500 MHz
42X
500 MHz
43X
500 MHz
44X
500 MHz
49X
500 MHz
533EB MHz
61X
533EB MHz
62X
533EB MHz
63X
533B MHz
64X
533B MHz
PC 300 - 6565/6566
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 305. video card = SR9 AGP2X with S3 Savage4 - 8MB or SR9 AGP4X with S3 Savage4 Xtreme - 16MB SGRAM. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 306
307
308
Memory 128 MB 64 MB 64 MB N/A N/A N/A 64 MB 64 MB 64 MB 64 MB 128 MB 20.4 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 N/A Windows NT 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 N/A Windows 98 N/A N/A 4X4 N/A N/A N/A N/A 4X4 N/A N/A N/A N/A 4X4 N/A N/A 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 40X Max Windows 98 10.1 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 40X Max Windows NT 20.4 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16MB 4X4 40X Max Windows NT Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
65X
533EB MHz
66X
533EB MHz
67X
533EB MHz
800 MHz
866 MHz
600EB MHz
82X
600EB MHz
83X
600EB MHz
84X
600EB MHz
85X
600EB MHz
86X
600EB MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 305. video card = SR9 AGP2X with S3 Savage4 - 8MB or SR9 AGP4X with S3 Savage4 Xtreme - 16MB SGRAM. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 306
Model
Processor
87X
600EB MHz
88X
600B MHz
89X
600B MHz
667 MHz
92X
667 MHz
93X
667 MHz
96X
667 MHz
97X
667 MHz
733 MHz
99X
667 MHz
9AX
667 MHz
PC 300 - 6565/6566
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 305. video card = SR9 AGP2X with S3 Savage4 - 8MB or SR9 AGP4X with S3 Savage4 Xtreme - 16MB SGRAM. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 306
309
310
Memory 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 64 MB ECC 64 MB ECC 64 MB ECC 64 MB ECC 64 MB ECC 64 MB ECC 64 MB ECC 64 MB ECC 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 2000 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 2000 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT 13.5 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 15 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 N/A Windows 2000 15 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 2000 15 GB EIDE S3 AGP2 - 8MB 4X4 N/A Windows NT Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
9BX
667 MHz
9CX
600B MHz
9DX
667 MHz
A1(J)
600EB MHz
A2(J)
600EB MHz
A3(J)
533EB MHz
A4(J)
533EB MHz
A5(J)
533EB MHz
B1(J)
667 MHz
B2(J)
667 MHz
B3(J)
667 MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 305. video card = SR9 AGP2X with S3 Savage4 - 8MB or SR9 AGP4X with S3 Savage4 Xtreme - 16MB SGRAM. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 306
Model
Processor
C1(J)
733 MHz
C2(J)
733 MHz
D1(J)
533B MHz
D2(J)
533B MHz
E1X
733 MHz
E2X
733 MHz
E3X
733 MHz
E4X
733 MHz
E5X
733 MHz
E6X
733 MHz
E7X
733 MHz
PC 300 - 6565/6566
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 305. video card = SR9 AGP2X with S3 Savage4 - 8MB or SR9 AGP4X with S3 Savage4 Xtreme - 16MB SGRAM. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 306
311
312
Memory 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 128 MB 30 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT 30 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 30 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16MB 4X4 48X Max Windows NT 30 GB EIDE S3 AGP4 - 16MB 4X4 48X Max Windows 98 Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
F1X
800 MHz
F2X
800 MHz
G1X
866 MHz
G2X
866 MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 305. video card = SR9 AGP2X with S3 Savage4 - 8MB or SR9 AGP4X with S3 Savage4 Xtreme - 16MB SGRAM. Processor = Pentium III Audio = integrated on system board. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 306
Notes:
PC 300 - 6565/6566
313
8 2 3 4 1 18 17 16 19
314
15
14
13
12
11
10
Parts listing
Index 1 2 2 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 8 9 9 System (Type 6565/6566) Top Cover Assembly Power Supply-145W Power Supply-145W (China) Power Supply-145W (Japan) Fan Duct Kit C2 security switch assembly Hard File/Floppy Bracket RFID antenna Bezel Kit CD-ROM (40X Max) CD-ROM (48X Max) 1.44 MB, 3.5-Inch Diskette Drive 1.44 MB, 3.5-Inch Diskette Drive (Japan) Order either of the 10.1 GB hard drives below 10.1 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 10.1 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 13.5 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 15.0 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive Order either of the below 20.4 GB hard drives 20.4 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 20.4 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 30.0 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 9.1 GB SCSI Hard Disk Drive 7200 rpm Front Bezel Assembly Fan/Card Guide Assembly Memory - 64 MB ECC Memory - 64 MB SDRAM Memory - 128 MB SDRAM System Board - for 500/533B/600B processors (no processor, no memory) System Board - for 533EB/600EB and higher processors (no processor, no memory) Pentium III 500/100 MHz. Pentium III 533B/133 MHz. Pentium III 600B/133 MHz. Pentium III 533EB/133 MHz. Pentium III 600EB/133 MHz Pentium III 667 MHz Pentium III 733 MHz Pentium III 800 MHz Pentium III 866 MHz Chassis Assembly Ethernet Adapter - Lake Clark 2.4 SCSI Adapter - Adaptec 2940 Key lock assembly Pedestal (Order via OBI option) Cable - ATA-66 2 Drop Cable - CD-ROM Audio Cable - Diskette Drive Cable - Hard Disk Cable, ATA Cable - SCSI, hard disk Cable - Wake On Ring EMC Shield Kit for System Board Foot (4) FRU No. 09K9825 01K9870 36L8815 20L2314 37L4995 09K9827 09K9847 03K9654 37L5097 36L8789 09N0735 75H9550 75H9552
10 10 10 10
10 10 10 10 11 12 13 13 13 14 14
36L8628 37L5723 09N0925 36L8648 37L5096 37L5093 33L3080 33L3072 33L3074 61H2533 61H2578
15 15 15 15 15 15 15 15 15 16 17 17 18 19
00N3879 33L4066 01N2657 09N3462 37L6034 00N3622 00N7174 09N9097 09N4877 09K9823 34L1109 10L7122 09K9829 33L5136 37L5098 75H9219 33L2596 37L4525 10K0805 76H7345 37L5095 03K9655
PC 300 - 6565/6566
315
Index
System (Type 6565/6566) EMC Shield for 5.25-inch Bay LED/Power Switch Assembly LED/Power Switch Assembly with SCSI LED Lithium Battery Miscellaneous Hardware Kit Mouse - Scrollpoint 2 Name Plate, PC 300 GL (6565, 6566) Power Button Savage4 Video Card-100 2xAGP Savage2 Video Card-143 4xAGP Video Card 4xAGP Dongle Speaker/Cable Assembly URM retainer Kit X-wide upper bay bezel X-wide lower bay bezel
FRU No. 20L3073 37L5092 19K8118 33F8354 20L3094 28L1865 00N6083 10K1705 09N5898 33L1618 09N3435 01K4909 33L4521 10K1707 10K1709
316
PC 300 - 6565/6566
317
Display and Monitor Information Display and monitor information is separately available and is listed under Related publications on page v.
Special tools
The following tools are required to service these computers: A volt-ohm meter, IBM P/N 73G5404 Wrap Plug, IBM P/N 72X8546
318
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
This section contains the general checkout procedures, additional service information, computer exploded view, Symptom-to-FRU indexes, undetermined problem, model tables, and parts listings for the IBM IntelliStation, type 6868/6878 computer. Note Service information is the same for types 6868 computers, unless specifically identified as type 6868 which is the desktop computer. Note This manual and the diagnostic tests are intended to test only IBM products. Non-IBM products of any kind including adapter cards, accelerator boards, options, or non-IBM devices, can give false errors and invalid computer responses. If you remove a non-IBM device and the symptom goes away, the problem is with the device you removed. General checkout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Module test menu and hardware configuration report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-pin main power supply connection . . . . Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Diagnostics and test information . . . . . . . . Power-on self-test (POST) . . . . . . . . . POST beep codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . Error code format . . . . . . . . . . . . . IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics . . . . . . . Starting the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Navigating through the diagnostic programs . Running diagnostic tests . . . . . . . . . . Test selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IBM PC Enhanced Memory Diagnostics . . . Alert On LAN test . . . . . . . . . . . . . Asset ID test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Test results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hard file Smart test . . . . . . . . . . . . IBM Fixed Disk Optimized Test . . . . . . . Quick and Full erase - hard drive . . . . . . Iomega Zip Drive Test . . . . . . . . . . . Asset EEPROM backup . . . . . . . . . . Viewing the test log . . . . . . . . . . . . SIMM/DIMM/RIMM memory errors . . . . Setup Utility program . . . . . . . . . . . . Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322 325 326 326 327 328 329 330 330 330 331 332 332 332 333 333 333 334 334 334 335 335 336 336 336 337 337 339
319
Hard disk drive boot error . . . . . . . . . When to use the Low-Level Format program Preparing the hard disk drive for use . . . . Product description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Specifications Type 6868/6878 . . . . . . . Additional service information . . . . . . . . . Replacing a processor . . . . . . . . . . . Replacing a system board . . . . . . . . . Security features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Passwords . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power-on password . . . . . . . . . . . Administrator password . . . . . . . . . Administrator password control . . . . . Operating system password . . . . . . . Vital product data . . . . . . . . . . . . . Management Information Format (MIF) . . . Alert on LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Asset ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hard disk drive jumper settings . . . . . . . IDE hard disk drive settings . . . . . . . CD-ROM drive jumper settings . . . . . . . BIOS levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flash (BIOS/VPD) update procedure . . . . Flash recovery boot block . . . . . . . . . Power management . . . . . . . . . . . . Automatic configuration and power interface (ACPI) BIOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . Advanced Power Management . . . . . Automatic Hardware Power Management features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting Automatic Hardware Power Management features . . . . . . . . . Automatic Power-On features . . . . . . Enhanced Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . Network settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flash over LAN (update POST/BIOS over network) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Wake on LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System board memory . . . . . . . . . . . RIMM diagnostic approach . . . . . . . Computer exploded view (Type 6868/6878) . . . Input/Output connectors . . . . . . . . . . Side cover removal . . . . . . . . . . . . Top handle cover removal . . . . . . . . . Bezel removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Top drive cage removal . . . . . . . . . . Lower drive cage removal . . . . . . . . . Adapter removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Support rail removal . . . . . . . . . . . . Air Baffle removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . Terminator card removal . . . . . . . . . . RIMM memory removal . . . . . . . . . . RIMM memory installation . . . . . . . . . Lithium battery removal . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
339 340 340 341 342 343 343 344 344 344 345 346 346 346 346 346 347 347 349 349 350 351 352 352 353 353 353 353 354 354 355 356 356 357 358 359 360 361 362 362 363 363 364 364 365 365 365 366 366 366
320
Lithium battery installation . . . . . . . . System board layout . . . . . . . . . . . . System board locations . . . . . . . . . System board jumper settings . . . . . . Symptom-to-FRU index . . . . . . . . . . . Beep symptoms . . . . . . . . . . . . . No beep symptoms . . . . . . . . . . . POST error codes . . . . . . . . . . . . Miscellaneous error messages . . . . . . Undetermined problem . . . . . . . . . . . Model tables - Country/Region/Language . . . Type/Model configuration tables (6868/6878) Parts (Type 6868/6878) . . . . . . . . . . . Parts listing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Special tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
366 367 368 369 370 371 372 374 389 392 393 394 403 404 407
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
321
General checkout
This general checkout procedure is for IntelliStation Type 6868/6878 computers. Attention The drives in the computer you are servicing might have been rearranged or the drive startup sequence changed. Be extremely careful during write operations such as copying, saving, or formatting. Data or programs can be overwritten if you select an incorrect drive. Diagnostic error messages appear when a test program finds a problem with a hardware option. For the test programs to properly determine if a test Passed, Failed, or Aborted, the test programs check the error-return code at test completion. See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics on page 332. General error messages appear if a problem or conflict is found by an application program, the operating system, or both. For an explanation of these messages, refer to the information supplied with that software package. Notes 1. Before replacing any FRUs, ensure the latest level of BIOS is installed on the system. A down-level BIOS might cause false errors and unnecessary replacement of the system board. For more information on how to determine and obtain the latest level BIOS, see BIOS levels on page 351. 2. If multiple error codes are displayed, diagnose the first error code displayed. 3. If the computer hangs with a POST error, go to Symptom-to-FRU index on page 370. 4. If the computer hangs and no error is displayed, go to Undetermined problem on page 392. 5. If an installed device is not recognized by the diagnostics program, that device might be defective. The power-on default is quick bring-up. To enable Enhanced bring-up, select the Start Options in the Configuration/Setup Utility program (see Setup Utility program on page 339) then, enable Power On Status. 001 Power-off the computer and all external devices. Check all cables and power cords. Make sure the system board is seated properly. Set all display controls to the middle position. (Step 001 continues)
322
001 (continued) Insert the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics diskette into drive A. Power-on all external devices. Power-on the computer. Check for the following response: 1. Readable instructions or the Main Menu. Note Type 6868/6878 computers default to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 339. DID YOU RECEIVE THE CORRECT RESPONSE? Yes No 002 If the Power Management feature is enabled, do the following: 1. Start the Configuration/Setup Utility program (see Setup Utility program on page 339) 2. Select Power Management from the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 3. Select APM 4. Be sure APM BIOS Mode is set to Disabled. If it is not, press Left Arrow ( ) or Right Arrow ( ) to change the setting. 5. Select Automatic Hardware Power Management. 6. Set Automatic Hardware Power Management to Disabled. or Go to the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics on page 332. 003 Run the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics test. If necessary, refer to Diagnostics and test information on page 330. If you receive an error, replace the part that the diagnostic program calls out or go to IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics on page 332. If the test stops and you cannot continue, replace the last device tested. If the computer has incorrect keyboard responses, go to Keyboard on page 326. (Step 003 continues)
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
323
(CONTINUED)
003 (continued) If the printer has incorrect responses, go to Printer on page 326. If the display has problems such as jittering, rolling, shifting, or being out of focus, go to Display on page 329.
324
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
325
Keyboard
Note If a mouse or other pointing device is attached, remove it to see if the error symptom goes away. If the symptom goes away, the mouse or pointing device is defective. 001 Power-off the computer. Disconnect the keyboard cable from the system unit. Power-on the computer and check the keyboard cable connector on the system unit for the voltages shown. All voltages are 5%.
Pin 1 2 3 4
5
6
6 4 2
5 3 1
ARE THE VOLTAGES CORRECT? Yes No 002 Replace the system board. 003 On keyboards with a detachable cable, replace the cable. If the problem remains or if the cable is permanently attached to the keyboard, replace the keyboard. If the problem remains, replace the system board.
Printer
1. Make sure the printer is properly connected and powered on. 2. Run the printer self-test. If the printer self-test does not run correctly, the problem is in the printer. Refer to the printer service manual. If the printer self-test runs correctly, install a wrap plug in the parallel port and run the diagnostic tests to determine which FRU failed. If the diagnostic tests (with the wrap plug installed) do not detect a failure, replace the printer cable. If that does not correct the problem, replace the system board or adapter connected to the printer cable.
326
Power supply
If the power-on indicator is not on, the power-supply fan is not running, or the computer will not power-off, do the following.
Check/Verify 1. Verify that the voltage-selector switch is set for the correct voltage. 2. Check the following for proper installation. Power Cord On/Off Switch connector On/Off Switch Power Supply connector System Board Power Supply connectors microprocessor(s) connection 3. Check the power cord for proper continuity. 4. Check the power-on switch for continuity. FRU/Action Correct the voltage-selector switch setting. Reseat
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
327
11
20
Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
Signal 3.3 V 3.3 V COM 5V COM 5V COM POK 5VSB 12 V 3.3 V -12 V COM PS-ON COM COM COM -5 V 5V 5V
Function +3.3 V dc +3.3 V dc Ground +5 V dc Ground +5 V dc Ground Power Good Standby Voltage +12 V dc +3.3 V dc -12 V dc Ground DC Remote Enable Ground Ground Ground -5 V dc +5 V dc +5 V dc
If the voltages are not correct, and the power cord is good, replace the power supply.
328
Display
If the screen is rolling, replace the display assembly. If that does not correct the problem, replace the video adapter (if installed) or replace the system board. If the screen is not rolling, do the following to run the display self-test: 1. 2. 3. 4. Power-off the computer and display. Disconnect the display signal cable. Power-on the display. Turn the brightness and contrast controls clockwise to their maximum setting. 5. Check for the following conditions: You should be able to vary the screen intensity by adjusting the contrast and brightness controls. The screen should be white or light gray, with a black margin (test margin) on the screen. Note The location of the test margin varies with the type of display. The test margin might be on the top, bottom, or one or both sides. If you do not see any test margin on the screen, replace the display. If there is a test margin on the screen, replace the video adapter (if installed) or replace the system board. Note During the first two or three seconds after the display is powered on, the following might occur while the display synchronizes with the computer. Unusual patterns or characters Static, crackling, or clicking sounds A power-on hum on larger displays A noticeable odor might occur on new displays or displays recently removed from storage. These sounds, display patterns, and odors are normal; do not replace any parts. If you are unable to correct the problem, go to Undetermined problem on page 392.
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
329
330
Note Type 6868/6878 computers default to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: 1. Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 339.
RDDDPLSCB QEET Test state Error code Extension Qualifier Bus ( =internal 1=external) Capacity of the device Slot number of the device LUN (usually ) PUN (SCSI ID #) Device Number Reserved Digit (usually )
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
331
This diagnostic diskette includes: A new user interface (WaterGate Software's PC-Doctor) This interface serves as the control program for running both the IBM PC Enhanced Memory Diagnostics and the suite of diagnostic tests provided by PC-Doctor. IBM PC PC Enhanced Memory Diagnostics The memory diagnostic tests determine which memory module (SIMM, DIMM, or RIMM) is defective and report the socket where the failing module is located. The Memory diagnostics can run a quick and full test of the system. Diagnostics can also be run on a single memory module. Note See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnosticsfor the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics error codes.
332
Use the cursor movement keys to navigate within the menus. The Enter key is used to select a menu item. The Esc key is used to back up to the previous menu. For online help select F1.
Test selection
To select one or more tests: 1. Open the corresponding test category. 2. Using the cursor movement keys, highlight the desired test. 3. Press Space bar. A selected test is marked with a chevron, >>. Pressing the space bar again de-selects a test and removes the chevron. 4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 above to select all desired tests.
333
2. Highlight either the 'Memory Test-Full' or 'Memory Test-Quick option and press Enter. Memory Test-Full The full memory test will take about 80 seconds per MB of memory and will detect marginal, intermittent, and solid (stuck) memory failures. Memory Test-Quick The quick memory test will take about 20 seconds per MB of memory and will detect solid (stuck) memory failures only. Notes Either level of memory testing can be performed on all memory or a single SIMM/DIMM socket. Only sockets containing a SIMM or DIMM can be selected for testing. Unpopulated sockets are noted by ........ besides the test description.
Asset ID test
The Asset ID test does the following: Determines if Asset ID is supported on the system. Verifies the EEPROM areas. Performs an antenna detection test.
Test results
IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostic test results will produce this error code format:
Function Failure Code Type DeviceID Date ChkDigits Text
Represents the feature or function within the PC. Represents the type of error encountered. Contains the component's unit-id which corresponds to either a fixed disk drive, removable media drive, serial or parallel port, processor, specific DIMM, or a device on the PCI bus.
334
Date:
ChkDigits:
Text: Note
Contains the date on which the diagnostic test was run. Date is retrieved from CMOS and displayed using the YYYYMMDD format. Contains a 2-digit check-digit value to ensure that: Diagnostics were run on the specified date Diagnostics were run on the specified IBM computer The diagnostic error code is recorded correctly Description of the error.
See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics error codes on page 1 for error code listings.
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
335
336
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
337
Failure Found Information in BIOS is not as expected. Not able to find expected DMI information from BIOS. Memory controller chipset vendor ID does not match expected value.
Recommended Actions Reflash the BIOS. Perform boot block recovery. Replace the system board.
Restart test.
"Y" is the SIMM/DIMM/RIMM socket number. Use the System Board Layouts section in the latest PC 300/700, IntelliStation Hardware Maintenance Manual, HMM, to reference the memory sockets.
338
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
339
Actions The drive must be formatted, do the following: 1. Attempt to access and recover (back-up) the failing hard disk drive. 2. Using the operating systems programs, format the hard disk drive. 3. Go to Preparing the hard disk drive for use on page 340.
340
Product description
The IntelliStation Type 6868/6878 computer is available in 6 x 7, (Six drive bays, seven I/O adapter slots, including an AGP socket) as minitower models. Security Administrator password Operating system password Power-on password Cover lock C2 security U-bolt and cable Startup sequence control Startup without diskette, keyboard, or mouse Unattended startup mode Diskette and hard drive I/O control Serial and parallel port I/O control Security profile by device IBM Security Solutions
CMOS backup battery (lithium) Common parts (Varies with each model, see Type/Model configuration tables (6868/6878) on page 394.) Diskette drive Hard disk drive Keyboard Power supply Mouse
Specifications Information (ISO/ANSI) The model specifications information on the following pages was determined in controlled acoustical environments according to procedures specified by the American National Standards Institute (ANSI) S12.10 and ISO 7779, and are reported in accordance with ISO 9296. Actual sound pressure levels in your location might differ from the average values stated because of room reflections and other nearby noise sources. The declared sound power levels indicate an upper limit, below which a large proportion of machines will operate.
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
341
Weight Environment
Heat Output
Electrical Input
342
Replacing a processor
Make sure the processor is fully seated in its socket and that the goal post latches are engaged. Important Make sure the air baffle is installed to prevent processor overheating. If the processor is not installed correctly, the system board and the processor can be damaged.
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
343
Security features
Security features in this section include: Passwords Vital Product Data Management Information Format (MIF) Alert on LAN Asset ID
Passwords
The following provides information about computer hardware and software-related passwords: Power-on Password Administrator Password Operating System Password Power-on and Administrator passwords are set in the Setup Utility program. See Setup Utility program on page 339 for information about running the Setup Utility.
344
Power-on password: A power-on password denies access to the computer by an unauthorized user when the computer is powered on. When a power-on password is active, the password prompt appears on the screen each time the computer is powered on. The computer starts after the proper password is entered.
Removing a power-on password To service a computer with an active and unknown power-on password, power-off the computer and do the following: Attention If Enhanced Security is not enabled, this procedure will remove the administrator password, all setup and boot sequence settings and privilege access. Make sure these settings are recorded before you perform this procedure. If Enhanced Security is enabled, Only Enhanced Security functions like boot sequence and privilege access will not be changed. Other settings will be cleared 1. Unplug the power cord and remove the top cover. 2. Refer to System board layout on page 367 to find the ROM Recover jumper. 3. Move the ROM Recover jumper to pins2,3 position. 4. Power-on the computer. The system senses the change in the position and erases the password. It is necessary to move the ROM Recover jumper to pins1,2 position. 5. Remind the user to enter a new password when service is complete.
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
345
Administrator password: The administrator password is used to restrict access to the Configuration/Setup Utility program. If the administrator password is activated, and you do not enter the administrator password, the configuration can be viewed but not changed.
Note Type 6868/6878 have Enhanced Security Mode. If Enhanced Security mode is enabled and there is no password given, the computer will act as if Enhanced Security is disabled. If Enhanced Security is Enabled and an administrator password is given, the administrator password must be entered to use the computer. If the administrator password is lost or forgotten, the system board in the computer must be replaced in order to regain access to the Configuration/Setup Utility program.
Administrator password control The Administrator password is set in the Setup Configuration. Refer to Setup Utility program on page 339 Operating system password: An operating system password is very similar to a power-on password and denies access to the computer by an unauthorized user when the password is activated. The computer is unusable until the password is entered and recognized by the computer.
346
The customer has the option to purchase serial number information and services from Retain-a-Group. It is the customer's responsibility to maintain the MIF file and to inform Retain-a-Group of any changes to the file. Some customers may request their servicers to assist them in maintaining the MIF file when serialized components are replaced during hardware service. This assistance is between the customer and the servicer. The servicer can use the DMI MIF Browser to update the MIF information in the EPROM. It is anticipated that some servicers might charge for this service. To update the EPROM using the DMI MIF Browser: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Click Start from the desktop, then Programs. Select IBM SystemView Agent. Select Serial Number Information icon. Click the plus sign to expand. Select the component you want to view or edit. Double click on the component you want to change. Enter new data in the Value field, then click Apply.
Alert on LAN
Alert on LAN provides notification of changes in the computer, even when the computer power is turned off. Working with DMI and Wake on LAN technologies, Alert on LAN helps to manage and monitor the hardware and software features of the computer. Alert on LAN generates notifications to the server of these occurrences: Computer disconnected from the network Computer unplugged from the power outlet All POST errors Operating system or POST hang condition Alert on LAN events are configured to be Enabled or Disabled from the LAN server only, and not from the computer. See the LAN administrator for configuration status information.
Asset ID
Asset ID is the application of using radio frequency technology to communicate with the AssetCare EEPROM described above. Asset ID assists customers in performing electronic property pass, system deployment, and physical inventory applications using radio frequency equipment from third party vendors. The electronic property pass application can be set so that if unauthorized removal of the PC from the enterprise occurs an administrator password is required during the next boot up of the system. Asset ID Enablement can be enabled or disabled under System Security in Setup/Configuration Utility.
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
347
Note Disabling both AssetCare and Asset ID will disable the RF antenna testing during POST and will not cause a POST error 184 (No RFID Antenna).
348
IDE Drives
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
349
AUDIO
RGGL
39 40
IDE INTERFACE
1 2
DC INPUT
5V G G 12V
CD-ROM, PD/CD-ROM Type 2X CD-ROM FRU 06H5906 4X CD-ROM FRU 06H7654 6X CD-ROM 8X CD-ROM 6X PD/CD-ROM 16X Max CD-ROM 24X Max CD-ROM 32X Max CD-ROM 40X Max CD-ROM 48X Max CD-ROM
Primary (Master) : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : :
Secondary (Slave) : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : : :
350
BIOS levels
An incorrect level of BIOS can cause false error and unnecessary FRU replacement. Use the following information to determine the current level of BIOS installed in the computer, the latest BIOS available for the computer, and where to obtain the latest level of BIOS. Current Level BIOS information. Run the Configuration Utility to determine the level of BIOS installed. Sources for determining the latest level BIOS available. 1. IBM PC Company Home Page http://www.ibm.com/pc/us/ 2. PC PartnerInfo-Technical Database (CTSTIPS.NSF) 3. HelpCenter 4. Levels 1 and 2 Support 5. RETAIN Sources for obtaining the latest level BIOS available. 1. IBM PC Company Home Page http://www.ibm.com/pc/us/ 2. PC PartnerInfo-Technical Database (CTSTIPS.NSF) 3. HelpCenter 4. Levels 1 and 2 Support To update (flash) the BIOS, see Flash (BIOS/VPD) update procedure on page 352.
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
351
352
Power management
Power management reduces the power consumption of certain components of the computer such as the system power supply, processor, hard disk drives, and some monitors. Advanced Power Management and Rapid Resume Manager are features of some personal computers.
Automatic configuration and power interface (ACPI) BIOS: Being an ACPI BIOS
system, the operating system is allowed to control the power management features of the computer and the setting for Advanced Power Management (APM) BIOS mode are ignored. Not all operating systems support ACPI BIOS mode.
Energy-saving settings can be viewed and changed by using the Advanced Power Management menu in the Configuration/Setup Utility program. Attention If a device, such as a monitor, does not have power-management capabilities, it can be damaged when exposed to a reduced-power state. Before making energy-saving selections for the monitor, check the documentation supplied with the monitor to see if it supports Display Power Management Signaling (DPMS).
At each level, you can define the amount of energy savings by specifying values for the following options: System Power: Select On for the computer to remain on. Select Off for the computer to shut down. Processor Speed:
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
353
Set the microprocessor to be disabled, or to run at 1, 10, 25, or 50 percent of its internal clock speed. Display: Set display to be disabled or to be reduced at these power states: Standby: Screen is blank, but can be restored immediately when any activity is detected. Suspend: Monitor uses less power than in Standby mode. Screen image is restored after a few seconds when any activity is detected. Off: Monitor power is off. Press Monitor power button to restore power. On some monitors, you might have to depress the power button twice.
The Automatic Power-On features within the Advanced Power Management menu allow you to enable and disable features that turn the computer on automatically. Serial Port Ring Detect: With this feature set to Enabled and an external modem connected to serial port (COM1), the computer will turn on automatically when a ring is detected on the modem.
354
Modem Ring Detect: With this feature set to Enabled, the computer will turn on automatically when a ring is detected on the internal modem. Wake Up on Alarm: You can specify a date and time at which the computer will be turned on automatically. This can be either a single event or a daily event. PCI Wake Up: PCI Wake Up uses PCI Power Management Enabled (PME) to wake up the computer when using token-ring, Ethernet LAN adapters, modems, or other PCI cards capable of waking up the computer. When you set PCI Wake Up to Enabled, the computer will turn on when it receives a specific signal from another computer on the local area network (LAN) or from a modem signal. Wake on LAN features can be used on the 6868 computer. For further information, see Wake on LAN on page 357.
Enhanced Security
Note Type 6868/6878 have Enhanced Security Mode. If Enhanced Security mode is enabled and there is no password given, the computer will act as if Enhanced Security is disabled. If Enhanced Security is Enabled and an administrator password is given, the administrator password must be entered to use the computer. If the administrator password is lost or forgotten, the system board in the computer must be replaced in order to regain access to the Configuration/Setup Utility program. Enhanced Security is an additional security feature available on type 6868/6878. Enhanced Security can be enabled or disabled only when you update system programs. If Enhanced Security is enabled and the administrator password has not been set, the computer will operate as if Enhanced Security is disabled. If Enhanced Security is enabled and the administrator password has been set, the computer has these additional security measures: The contents of the security EEPROM (the administrator password and startup sequence) are protected if the battery or CMOS memory fails. The security EEPROM is protected from unauthorized access. The security EEPROM cannot be read from or written to by any software application or system software until Enhanced Security is disabled and the IntelliStation - 6868/6878
355
computer is restarted. In a network environment, this might prevent certain functions from being performed on the computer. Remote Administration is locked and cannot be unlocked until Enhanced Security is disabled and the computer is restarted. This prevents the system programs in the computer from being updated remotely. The configuration settings in the Configuration/Setup Utility program are protected and cannot be changed until the administrator password has been entered. Any changes in computer hardware detected by the system programs in the computer will generate a configuration error until the administrator password has been entered. To enable or disable Enhanced Security: 1. Insert a system programs update diskette into the diskette drive (drive A). System programs updates are available at http://www.ibm.com/pc/support/us/ on the World Wide Web. 2. Power-on the computer. If it is powered on, you must power-off then power-on. 3. The update begins, the computer halts, and you are prompted for the administrator password (if you have set an administrator password). The computer remains in a halted state until the administrator password is entered. 4. When the administrator password is entered, or if no administrator password has been set, the update diskette will continue to run, and you are given the option of enabling or disabling Enhanced Security. The choice is automatically recorded in the System Security menu of the Configuration/Setup Utility program.
Network settings
This section applies only to computers linked to a network. The Configuration/Setup Utility program includes settings that can be enabled and disabled to configure the network interface in the computer. These settings are: Flash over LAN (Update POST/BIOS over Network) Wake on LAN
356
a network server. If the administrator password is set in the computer, it does not have to be entered by the server. To access the Flash over LAN setting: 1. Start the Configuration/Setup Utility program. See Setup Utility program on page 339. 2. Select System Security. 3. Select POST/BIOS Update from the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 4. To enable Flash over LAN, select Enabled. To disable Flash over LAN, select Disabled. 5. Press Esc twice to return to the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 6. Before you exit from the program, select Save Settings from the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 7. To exit from the Configuration/Setup Utility program, press Esc and follow the instructions on the screen.
Wake on LAN
This setting is used to enable or disable the IBM-developed Wake on LAN feature. This feature makes it possible for the computer to be turned on remotely by a network server. Remote network management software must be used in conjunction with this feature. To access the Wake on LAN setting: 1. Start the Configuration/Setup Utility program. See Setup Utility program on page 339. 2. Select Advanced Power Management. 3. Select Automatic Power On from the program menu. 4. Select Wake on LAN from the Automatic Power On menu. 5. To enable Wake on LAN, select Enabled. To disable Wake on LAN, select Disabled. 6. Press Esc until you return to the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 7. Before you exit from the program, select Save Settings from the Configuration/Setup Utility program menu. 8. To exit from the Configuration/Setup Utility program, press Esc and follow the instructions on the screen.
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
357
RIMM Memory Module Size 64 MB 128 MB 256 MB 512 MB 2 GB Maximum Memory PC600 PC800 Type RDRAM ECC/ Non-ECC
Supported RIMM memory configuration Type 6868/6878 has two memory channels with two memory sockets for each channel making a total of four RIMM memory sockets. RIMM sockets must have a RIMM memory module or a C-RIMM (RIMM Continuity module) installed. There can be no empty RIMM sockets. RIMM sockets must contain either a RIMM or a C-RIMM. At least one socket, from each memory channel, must have a RIMM memory module installed. Note Both memory channels must be populated the same. RIMM sockets 1 and 2 are on memory channel A. RIMM sockets 3 and 4 are on memory channel B. Each RIMM socket supports a maximum of 512 MB of memory. If new memory is to be added in a memory channel, remove a C-RIMM and install the new RIMM. (You must also do the same with the other memory Channel). If memory is to be removed from a memory channel, remove the RIMM and install a C-RIMM. (You must also do the same with the other memory Channel). RIMM sizes of 64 MB, 128 MB, 256 MB, and 512 MB are acceptable. RIMM sockets, within each memory channel, can be filled in any order. However, both memory
358
channels must be populated the same. ECC or non-ECC, RAMBUS dynamic random access memory (RDRAM) are supported. If ECC and non-ECC are installed together, all memory will function as non-ECC. Note Mixed RIMM speeds will run at the lower speed.
Identify any Beep or POST codes. See Symptom-to-FRU index on page 370. Use the IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics program to run memory tests. See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics on page 332. Procedures to determine memory errors: 1. If a memory error occurs, and the system is operational, run memory diagnostics. 2. If a memory error occurs, and the system is not operational: a. Replace one RIMM module at a time until the system comes up. Note All unused RIMM sockets must have a C-RIMM installed. Both memory channels must be populated the same. b. Run memory diagnostics. c. Replace the other RIMMs and run diagnostics again to identify the failing RIMM.
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
359
Input/Output connectors and removal procedures for the side cover, top handle, bezels, top and lower drive cage, adapter cards, support rail, air baffle, terminator card, RIMM memory, and lithium battery are on the following pages.
360
Input/Output connectors
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Keyboard connector USB-2 connector Parallel connector Audio line in Monitor connector SCSI connector PCI slot 5 PCI slot 4 PCI slot 3 PCI slot 2 PCI slot 1 AGP slot microphone Audio line out Ethernet Serial connector USB-1 connector Mouse connector
1 1
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
361
CoverRelease Tab
Unlock cover from back of the system unit before removing cover.
Attention Do not lift handle cover too high or the tabs will break.
362
Bezel removal
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
363
Note Make sure the vibration insulation mounts are installed on the cage when installing a disk drive.
Adapter removal
364
Note The baffle must be installed for proper air flow to the microprocessor(s).
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
365
Notches
Note Do not bend the top contact tab of the battery holder as it might not make connection with the battery.
366
37 36 35 34 33 32 31
123 123
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
367
368
ROM Recover jumper Note The ROM Recover jumper clears CMOS and is also used for Flash update and Flash recovery boot block.
Processor Speed Settings Processor speed for the IntelliStation type 6868/6878 computer is fixed and is determined by the processor. There are no settings required.
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
369
Symptom-to-FRU index
The Symptom-to-FRU index lists error symptoms and possible causes. The most likely cause is listed first. Always begin with General checkout on page 322. See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics error codes on page 1 when running diagnostics. This index can also be used to help you decide which FRUs to have available when servicing a computer. If you are unable to correct the problem using this index, go to Undetermined problem on page 392. Notes If you have both an error message and an incorrect audio response, diagnose the error message first. If you cannot run the diagnostic tests or you get a diagnostic error code when running a test, but did receive a POST error message, diagnose the POST error message first. If you did not receive any error message, look for a description of your error symptoms in the first part of this index. Check all power supply voltages before you replace the system board. (See Power supply on page 327.) Check the hard disk drive jumper settings before you replace a hard disk drive. (See Hard disk drive jumper settings on page 349.) Important 1. Some errors are indicated with a series of beep codes. (See Beep symptoms on page 371.) Type 6868/6878 computer defaults to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 339. 2. The processor is a separate FRU from the system board; the processor is not included with the system board FRU.
370
Beep symptoms
Beep symptoms are short tones or a series of short tones separated by pauses (intervals without sound). See the following examples.
Beeps 1-2-X Description One Beep A pause (or break) Two beeps A pause (or break) Any number of beeps Four continuous beeps FRU/Action 1. Run Setup 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. C-RIMM not installed 3. Memory channels not same 4. System Board 1. Keyboard 2. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Run Setup 2. System Board 2-1-X First 64 KB of RAM failed. 2-2-2 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Run Setup 2. Memory Module 3. System Board 1. System Board 1. System Board 2. Keyboard
4 Beep Symptom 1-1-3 CMOS read/write error 1-1-4 ROM BIOS check error 1-2-X DMA error 1-3-X
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
371
FRU/Action 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 3. Display 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 3. Display 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board
3-4-1 Screen retrace test detected an error. 3-4-2 POST is searching for video ROM. 4
All other beep code sequences. One long and one short beep during POST. Base 640 KB memory error or shadow RAM error. One long beep and two or three short beeps during POST. (Video error) Three short beeps during POST.
1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 1. See System board memory on page 358. 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. Keyboard stuck key? 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board
No beep symptoms
Note Type 6868/6878 computer defaults to come up quiet (No beep and no memory count and checkpoint code display) when no errors are detected by POST. To enable Beep and memory count and checkpoint code display when a successful POST occurs: Enable Power on Status in setup. See Setup Utility program on page 339.
372
FRU/Action 1. See Undetermined problem on page 392. 2. System Board 3. Memory Module 4. Any Adapter or Device 5. Power Cord 6. Power Supply
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
373
02X 08X Check SCSI terminator installation. 101 System board interrupt failure. 102 System board timer error. 106 110 System board memory parity error. 111 I/O channel parity error. 114 Adapter ROM error. 129 Internal cache test error. 151 Real-time clock failure. 161 Bad CMOS battery.
1. System Board
1. System Board 1. System Board 1. Memory Module 2. System Board 1. Reseat adapters 2. Any Adapter 3. System Board 1. Adapter Memory 2. System Board 1. Processor 2. L2 Cache Memory 3. System Board 1. System Board 1. Run Setup 2. CMOS Backup Battery (See page Safety information on page 434.) 3. System Board
374
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup and verify Configuration 2. Had a device been added, removed, changed location? If not, suspect that device. 3. Power-on external devices first, then power-on computer. 4. CMOS Backup Battery (See page Safety information on page 434.) 5. System Board 1. Diskette Drive 2. System Board 3. Diskette Drive Cable 1. Time and Date Set? 2. CMOS Backup Battery (See page Safety information on page 434.) 3. System Board 1. Run Setup. Check System Summary menu for memory size change. (See Setup Utility program on page 339.) 2. See System board memory on page 358. 3. Run memory tests. See IBM PC Enhanced Diagnostics on page 332. 1. Run Flash Recovery using Boot Block. See Flash recovery boot block on page 352 2. System Board 1. Run Setup. Check Stepping level for the BIOS level needed, then perform the flash update. 2. Processor 1. Run Setup. Check to see that Ethernet and Alert on LAN are enabled. 2. System Board 1. C2 Security
162 And unable to run diagnostics. 163 Clock not updating or invalid time set.
164 POST detected a base memory or extended memory size mismatch error.
17X, 18X
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
375
FRU/Action 1. Run Configuration (See Setup Utility program on page 339.) 2. System Board 1. Covers were removed from the computer. 1. Enter the administrator password 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. Enter the administrator password 1. Make sure Asset Care and Asset ID are enabled in Configuration/Setup. 2. RFID Antenna 3. System Board 1. Set configuration and reinstall the boot sequence. 1. System Board 1. Clear Administration password 2. System Board 1. More than three password attempts were made to access the computer. 1. System Board
189
190 Chassis intrusion detector was cleared. This is information only, no action required. If this code does not clear: 1XX Not listed above. 201, 20X Memory data error.
1. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diag. Memory Test 2. Memory Module 3. System Board 1. Unsupported Memory 1. L2 Cache Memory 2. System Board
376
POST Error Code 262 POST detected a base memory or extended memory type error.
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup. Check System Summary menu for memory type change. (See Setup Utility program on page 339.) 2. Run the Extended Memory Diagnostic tests. 1. Keyboard 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board 1. 2. 3. 4. Mouse Keyboard Keyboard Cable System Board
301
1. Keyboard 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board 1. Keyboard 2. Keyboard Cable 3. System Board 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board
601
1. Diskette Drive A 2. Diskette Drive Cable 3. System Board 1. Bad Diskette 2. Verify Diskette and retry. 3. Diskette Drive 4. Diskette Drive Cable 5. System Board 1. Run Setup and verify diskette configuration settings 2. Diskette Drive A/B 3. Diskette Drive Cable 4. System Board 1. Diskette Drive 2. Diskette Drive Cable 3. System Board 1. Diskette drive configuration error or wrong diskette drive type, run Setup Configuration. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Diskette Drive System Board External Drive Adapter Diskette Drive Cable Power Supply
602
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
377
POST Error Code 762 Math coprocessor configuration error. 7XX Not listed above. 962 Parallel port configuration error. 9XX 1047 107X Check SCSI terminator installation.
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup 2. Processor 3. System Board 1. Processor 2. System Board 1. Run Configuration 2. Parallel Adapter (if installed) 3. System Board 1. Printer 2. System Board 1. 16-Bit AT Fast SCSI Adapter 1. Check SCSI terminator installation. 2. SCSI Cable 3. SCSI Terminator 4. SCSI Device 5. SCSI Adapter 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics
1101 Serial connector error, possible system board failure. 1101, 1102, 1106, 1108, 1109 1107
1. System Board 2. Any Serial Device 1. Communications Cable 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. System Board 1. Serial Device Cable 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Configuration 2. Serial Adapter (if installed) 3. System Board
1102 Card selected feedback error. 1103 Port fails register check. 1106 Serial option cannot be turned off. 1107 1110 Register test failed. 1116 Interrupt error. 1117 Failed baud rate test. 1162 Serial port configuration error.
378
POST Error Code 11XX Not listed above. 1201 1202, 1206, 1208, 1209, 12XX
FRU/Action 1. System Board 1. System Board 2. Any Serial Device 1. Dual Async Adapter/A 2. System Board 3. Any Serial Device 1. Communications Cable 2. Dual Async Adapter/A 1. Game Adapter Information only Information only
1207
13XX 1402 Printer not ready. 1403 No paper error, or interrupt failure. 1404 System board timeout failure. 1405 Parallel adapter error. 1406 Presence test error. 14XX Not listed above. Check printer before replacing system board. 15XX 1692 Boot sequence error. 16XX 1762 Hard disk drive configuration error. 1780 1781 1782 1783 (Disk (Disk (Disk (Disk Drive Drive Drive Drive 0) 1) 2) 3)
1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Printer 2. System Board
1. SDLC Adapter 1. Run FDISK to ensure at least one active partition is set active. 1. 36/38 Workstation Adapter 1. Run Configuration (See Setup Utility program on page 339.) 1. See Power supply on page 327. 2. Hard Disk Drive 3. System Board 4. Hard Disk Cable 5. Power Supply
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
379
FRU/Action 1. Run Setup and verify PCI/ISA configuration settings. 2. If necessary, set ISA adapters to Not available to allow PCI adapters to properly configure. 3. Remove any suspect ISA adapters. 4. Rerun diagnostics. 5. PCI Adapter 1. Possible hard disk drive problem, see Hard disk drive boot error on page 339. 1. Diskette Drive 2. Diskette Cable 3. 16-bit AT Fast SCSI Adapter 1. BSC Adapter 1. SCSI Device 2. 16-bit AT Fast SCSI Adapter 3. Alternate BSC Adapter 1. Display 1. System Board 2. Display 1. Display 1. System Board 2. Display 1. Check cable connections. 2. Run Setup and verify video configuration settings. 3. Video Memory Modules 4. Video Adapter (if installed) 5. System Board 1. 2. 3. 4. Network Attached? LF Translator Cable Problem PC Network Adapter
209X
2401, 2402 If screen colors change. 2401, 2402 If screen colors are OK. 2409 2410 2462 Video memory configuration error.
3015, 3040 Check for missing wrap or terminator plug on the adapter. 30XX
380
FRU/Action 1. Network Attached? 2. LF Translator 3. Alternate PC Network-Adapter 4. Cable Problem 1. Alternate PC Network Adapter 2. LF Translator 3. Cable Problem 1. GPIB Adapter 1. DAC Adapter 1. Multiport/2 Interface Board 2. Multiport/2 Adapter 1. Memory Module Package 2. Multiport/2 Adapter 1. Multiport Interface Cable 1. Multiport/2 Adapter 2. Multiport/2 Interface Board 3. Memory Module 1. Financial System Controller Adapter 1. 2. 3. 4. Run Configuration CD-ROM Drive CD-ROM Adapter ZIP or other ATAPI device 5. System Board 1. 1st Store Loop Adapter 2. Adapter Cable 1. 2nd Store Loop Adapter 2. Adapter Cable 1. Network Adapter 1. Voice Adapter 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 1. Page Printer Adapter 1. High Speed Adapter 1. 3117 Adapter 1. PCMCIA Adapter 1. Speech Adapter 2. Speech Control Assy. 1. Pointing Device (Mouse) 2. System Board
31XX
5600 5962 An IDE device (other than hard drive) configuration error.
62XX
63XX
64XX 71XX 74XX 76XX 78XX 79XX 80XX 84XX 8601, 8602
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
381
FRU/Action 1. System Board 2. Pointing Device (Mouse) 1. Mouse 2. System Board 1. PC Music Adapter 2. MIDI Adapter Unit 1. Optical Drive 2. Adapter 1. SCSI Adapter 2. Any SCSI Device 3. System Board
1. Have customer verify correct operating system device drivers are installed and operational. 2. Modem 1. System Board 2. Data/Fax Modem 1. Check system speaker 2. Check PSTN cable 3. External DAA (if installed) 4. Modem 1. Run Diagnostics and verify the correct operation of the modem slot 2. Modem 1. Diagnostics detected a non-IBM modem 2. Modem 1. Check PSTN Cable 2. External DAA (if installed) 3. Modem
10118
10119
10120
1. Modem
1. Data/Fax Modem 2. System Board 1. Modem Adapter/A 2. Data/Fax Modem 3. System Board
382
POST Error Code 10450, 10451, 10490 10491, 10492, 10499 Read/write error. 10452 Seek test error. 10453 Wrong drive type? 10454 Sector buffer test error. 10455, 10456 Controller error. 10459 Drive diagnostic command error. 10461 Drive format error 10462 Controller seek error. 10464 Hard Drive read error. 10467 Drive non fatal seek error. 10468 Drive fatal seek error. 10469 Drive soft error count exceeded. 10470, 10471, 10472 Controller wrap error. 10473 Corrupt data. Low level format might be required. 10480
FRU/Action 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 2. Hard Disk Drive 3. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics Information only 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics Information only
1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics Information only
1. Hard Disk Drive (ESDI) 2. Drive Cable 3. System Board 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Run Enhanced Diagnostics 1. Check Configuration 2. Ethernet Adapter 1. Power-off computer, wait ten seconds; then power-on the computer. 2. Ethernet Adapter
10481 ESDI drive D seek error. 10482 Drive select acknowledgement bad. 106X1 10635
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
383
POST Error Code 10651, 10660 106XX Not listed above. 107XX
FRU/Action 1. Check Cables 2. Ethernet Adapter 1. Ethernet Adapter 1. 5.25-inch External Diskette Drive 2. 5.25-inch Diskette Drive Adapter/A 1. ActionMedia Adapter/A 2. System Board 1. SCSI Adapter 2. Any SCSI Device 3. System Board 1. 3119 Adapter 1. Modem Adapter 2. Any Serial Device 3. System Board 1. ISDN Primary Rate Adapter 2. System Board 1. System Board 1. Realtime Interface Coprocessor Portmaster Adapter/A 1. Japanese Display Adapter 2. System Board 1. System Board Video Adapter 2. Adapter Video Memory 1. Video Adapter 1. Video Adapter (if installed) 2. System Board 3. Display (any type) 1. External Display 2. Video Adapter 1. FaxConcentrator Adapter 1. 120 MB Internal Tape Drive 2. Diskette Cable 3. System Board 1. 6157 Tape Attachment Adapter 1. 6157 Streaming Tape Drive 2. 6157 Tape Attachment Adapter
109XX Check the adapter cables. 112XX This adapter does not have cache. 119XX 121XX
136XX
137XX 141XX
143XX
14710, 14711
384
FRU/Action 1. Token Ring Adapter 2. System Board 1. Wizard Adapter 2. Wizard Adapter Memory 1. Wizard Adapter Cable 1. DBCS Japanese Display Adapter/A 2. System Board 1. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 2. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 2. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 1. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 2. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Image Adapter/A Image-I Adapter/A 2. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 3. System Board 1. Printer/Scanner Option 2. Image Adapter/A 3. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 2. Printer/Scanner Option 3. Image Adapter/A 1. Printer/Scanner Option 2. Image Adapter/A 3. Memory Module DRAM, VRAM 1. Replace memory module (shown in graphic.) 1. SCSI-2 Adapter 2. Any SCSI Device 3. System Board 1. Any SCSI Device
20001 to 20003
20004
20005 to 20010
20101 to 20103
20104
20105 to 20110
208XX Verify there are no duplicate SCSI ID settings on the same bus.
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
385
POST Error Code 210XXXX Internal bus, size unknown. 210XXX1 External bus, size unknown.
FRU/Action 1. SCSI Hard Disk Drive 2. SCSI Adapter or System Board 3. SCSI Cable 4. SCSI ID Switch (on some models) 1. Tape Drive 2. SCSI Cable (internal) 3. SCSI Adapter or System Board 1. Tape Drive 2. SCSI Adapter or System Board 3. SCSI Cable (internal) SCSI Cable (external) 1. Tape Cassette 2. Drive 1. Rotary Switch Circuit Board 2. Circuit Board Cable 3. Tape Drive
Tape automatically ejected from drive. SCSI ID on rotary switch does not match SCSI ID set in configuration. Verify drive switches inside cover are set to zero. Tape sticks/breaks in drive. Verify that the tapes used meet ANSI standard X3B5. 212XX 213XX 214XX 215XXXC 215XXXD 215XXXE 215XXXU If an external device, and power-on LED is off, check external voltages. 216XX 217XX If an external device, and power-on LED is off, check external voltages. 218XX Check for multi CD tray, or juke box. 219XX
1. Tape Cassette
1. SCSI Printer 2. Printer Cable 1. SCSI Processor 1. WORM Drive 1. CD-ROM Drive I CD-ROM Drive II Enhanced CD-ROM Drive II Any CD-ROM Drive 2. SCSI Cable 3. SCSI Adapter or System Board 1. Scanner 1. Rewritable Optical Drive 2. SCSI Adapter or System Board 3. SCSI Cable 1. Changer
386
FRU/Action 1. ISDN/2 Adapter 2. ISDN/2 Wrap Plug 3. ISDN/2 Communications Cable 1. 1 Mbps Micro Channel Infrared LAN Adapter 1. ServerGuard Adapter 2. System Board 1. ServerGuard Adapter
273XX
27501, 27503 27506, 27507 27502, 27504, 27510 27511, 27533, 27534 27536, 27537 27509
1. Remove redundant adapters, run Auto Configuration program, then retest. 1. WMSELF.DGS diagnostics file missing. 2. WMSELF.DGS diagnostics file incorrect. 1. 3V Lithium Backup Battery 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. Internal Temperature out of range 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. ServerGuard Adapter 2. Power Supply 1. 7.2V NiCad Main Battery Pack 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. PCMCIA Type II Modem 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. External Power Control not connected 2. External Power Control 3. ServerGuard Adapter 1. External Power Control 2. ServerGuard Adapter 1. Update Diagnostic Software 1. Personal Dictation System Adapter 2. System Board 1. External FRU (Speaker, Microphone)
27512
27535
27554
27563, 27564
27880 to 27889
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
387
FRU/Action Possible hard disk drive problem, see Hard disk drive boot error on page 339.
388
Changing colors. Computer will not power-off. See Power supply on page 327. Computer will not RPL from server
Dead computer. See Power supply on page 327. Diskette drive in-use light remains on or does not light when drive is active. Flashing cursor with an otherwise blank display.
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
389
Message/Symptom Insert a Diskette icon appears with a known-good diagnostics diskette in the first 3.5-inch diskette drive. Intensity or color varies from left to right of characters and color bars. No power, or fan not running. Nonsystem disk or disk error-type message with a known-good diagnostic diskette. Other display symptoms not listed above (including blank or illegible display). Power-on indicator or hard disk drive in-use light not on, but computer works correctly. Printer problems. Program loads from the hard disk with a known-good diagnostics diskette in the first 3.5-inch diskette drive. RPL computer cannot access programs from its own hard disk.
FRU/Action 1. 2. 3. 4. Diskette Drive System Board Diskette Drive Cable Network Adapter
1. Display 2. System Board 1. See Power supply on page 327. 1. Diskette Drive 2. System Board 3. Diskette Drive Cable 1. See Display on page 329. 2. System Board 3. Display 1. Power Supply 2. System Board 3. LED Cables 1. See Printer on page 326. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Run Setup Diskette Drive Diskette Drive Cable System Board Power Supply
1. If network admin. is using LCCM Hybrid RPL, check startup sequence: First device: network; Second device: hard disk 2. Hard disk drive 1. Check startup sequence 2. Check the network adapter LED status 1. External Device Self-Test OK? 2. External Device 3. Cable 4. System Board 1. External Device Self-Test OK? 2. External Device 3. Cable 4. Alternate Adapter 5. System Board
390
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
391
Undetermined problem
Check the power supply voltages. See Power supply on page 327. If the voltages are correct, return here and continue with the following steps. 1. Power-off the computer. 2. Remove or disconnect the following, if installed, one at a time: a. Non-IBM devices b. External devices (modem, printer, or mouse) c. Any adapters d. Memory modules Before removing or replacing memory modules, see System board memory on page 358. e. Extended video memory f. External Cache g. External Cache RAM h. Hard disk drive i. Diskette drive 3. Power-on the computer to re-test the system. 4. Repeat steps 1 through 3 until you find the failing device or adapter. If all devices and adapters have been removed, and the problem continues, replace the system board. See Replacing a system board on page 344.
392
Asia Pacific (AP) AP English w/Keyboard AP English w/o Keyboard Japan (Japanese) Hong Kong (AP English) Hong Kong (Chinese) China (Chinese) China (AP English) Thailand (Thai) Taiwan (Chinese) Taiwan (AP English) Korea (Korean) Korea (AP English)
Model xxA xxB xxJ xxH xxM xxC xxD xxT xxV xxW xxK xxR
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
393
Page 395
394
Model
Processor
10X
600 MHz
11X
600 MHz
600 MHz
2x64 MB RIMM
13X
600 MHz
14X
600 MHz
2x64 MB RIMM
13.5 GB EIDE
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 393. Memory = PC600 Memory. ECC RAMBUS RIMM memory modules. Processor = Pentium III, 133 MHz. FSB. Audio = integrated on system board. Models Cxx, Dxx and Exx come with DOS license. Customer can install Operating System of their choice. SCSI adapter = Ultra 2 SCSI w/U2B. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 394
395
396
Memory 2x128 MB RIMM N/A 2x64 MB RIMM 2x64 MB RIMM 9.1 GB SCSI 7200 RPM 9.1 GB SCSI 7200 RPM Matrox G400 (AGP) 16MB 7X6 48X MAX Windows NT Appian Gemini (Dual Monitor) 16 MB 7X6 48X MAX Windows NT 13.5 GB EIDE Matrox G400 (AGP) 16MB 7X6 48X MAX Windows NT N/A N/A 7X6 N/A N/A 9.1 GB SCSI 10,000 RPM Fire GL1 (AGP) 32 MB 7X6 48X MAX Windows NT Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload 2x128 MB RIMM
Model
Processor
15X
600 MHz
600 MHz
20X
667 MHz
21X
667 MHz
22X
667 MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 393. Memory = PC600 Memory. ECC RAMBUS RIMM memory modules. Processor = Pentium III, 133 MHz. FSB. Audio = integrated on system board. Models Cxx, Dxx and Exx come with DOS license. Customer can install Operating System of their choice. SCSI adapter = Ultra 2 SCSI w/U2B. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 394
Model
Processor
23X
667 MHz
25X 2x128 MB RIMM N/A 2x64 MB RIMM 13.5 GB EIDE N/A 9.1 GB SCSI 10,000 RPM
667 MHz
2x128 MB RIMM
27X
667 MHz
667 MHz
30X
733 MHz
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 393. Memory = PC600 Memory. ECC RAMBUS RIMM memory modules. Processor = Pentium III, 133 MHz. FSB. Audio = integrated on system board. Models Cxx, Dxx and Exx come with DOS license. Customer can install Operating System of their choice. SCSI adapter = Ultra 2 SCSI w/U2B. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 394
397
398
Memory 2x128 MB RIMM 2x128 MB RIMM 2x128 MB RIMM 2x128 MB RIMM 2x128 MB RIMM N/A N/A N/A 7X6 N/A N/A 9.1 GB SCSI 10,000 RPM Intense 3D 4110 (AGP) 80 MB 7X6 48X MAX Windows NT 9.1 GB SCSI 7200 RPM Elsa GL II (AGP) 64 MB 7X6 48X MAX Windows NT 9.1 GB SCSI 10,000 RPM Fire GL1 (AGP) 32 MB 7X6 48X MAX Windows NT 9.1 GB SCSI 7200 RPM Matrox G400 (AGP) 16MB 7X6 48X MAX Windows NT 9.1 GB SCSI 7200 RPM Matrox G400 (AGP) 16MB 7X6 48X MAX Windows 2000 Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
31X
733 MHz
32X
733 MHz
35X
733 MHz
36X, C6X
733 MHz
37X
733 MHz
733 MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 393. Memory = PC600 Memory. ECC RAMBUS RIMM memory modules. Processor = Pentium III, 133 MHz. FSB. Audio = integrated on system board. Models Cxx, Dxx and Exx come with DOS license. Customer can install Operating System of their choice. SCSI adapter = Ultra 2 SCSI w/U2B. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 394
Model
Processor
40X, D0x
800 MHz
42X, D2x
800 MHz
46X, D6x
800 MHz
47X, D7x
800 MHz
800 MHz
50X, E0x
866 MHz
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 393. Memory = PC600 Memory. ECC RAMBUS RIMM memory modules. Processor = Pentium III, 133 MHz. FSB. Audio = integrated on system board. Models Cxx, Dxx and Exx come with DOS license. Customer can install Operating System of their choice. SCSI adapter = Ultra 2 SCSI w/U2B. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 394
399
400
Memory 2x128 MB RIMM 2x256 MB RIMM 2x256 MB RIMM N/A 2x128 MB RIMM 2x128 MB RIMM 9.1 SCSI 7200 RPM Matrox G400 (AGP) 16MB 7X6 48X MAX Windows NT 15.0 GB EIDE 7200 RPM Matrox G400 (AGP) 16MB 7X6 48X MAX Windows NT N/A N/A 7X6 N/A N/A 9.1 GB SCSI 10,000 RPM Intense 3D 4110 (AGP) 128 MB 7X6 48X MAX Windows NT 9.1 GB SCSI 10,000 RPM Elsa GL II (AGP) 64 MB 7X6 48X MAX Windows NT 9.1 GB SCSI 7200 RPM Matrox G400 (AGP) 16MB 7X6 48X MAX Windows NT Hard Drive Graphics Bays/Slots CD-ROM Preload
Model
Processor
52X, E2x
866 MHz
56X, E6x
866 MHz
57X, E7x
866 MHz
866 MHz
60X, G0x
933 MHz
62X, G2X
933 MHz
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 393. Memory = PC600 Memory. ECC RAMBUS RIMM memory modules. Processor = Pentium III, 133 MHz. FSB. Audio = integrated on system board. Models Cxx, Dxx and Exx come with DOS license. Customer can install Operating System of their choice. SCSI adapter = Ultra 2 SCSI w/U2B. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 394
Model
Processor
66X, G6X
933 MHz
67X, G7X
933 MHz
91X
600 MHz
92X
733 MHz
2x64 MB RIMM
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
N/A = Not included in model. For last digit model number, see Model tables - Country/Region/Language on page 393. Memory = PC600 Memory. ECC RAMBUS RIMM memory modules. Processor = Pentium III, 133 MHz. FSB. Audio = integrated on system board. Models Cxx, Dxx and Exx come with DOS license. Customer can install Operating System of their choice. SCSI adapter = Ultra 2 SCSI w/U2B. Open Bay = Authorized Assembler Program. See the note on page 394
401
Notes:
402
6 7 12
1 2
28
27
23
20
19
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
403
18
17 16 15 14
26
21
22
25 24
13
11
10
Parts listing
Index 1 2 3 4 5 5 6 System (Type 6868/6878) Handle/Cap Assembly Power Switch/LED Cable Assembly Top/Side Cover Assembly CD-ROM Drive (48X Max) 3.5-In. 1.44 MB Diskette Drive 3.5-In. 1.44 MB Diskette Drive - Japan Blank Louver Bezels (3.5-In. and 5.25-In.) Miscellaneous Optional Bezels 3.5-In. Bezel Assembly Name Plate RFID Antenna Front Bezel Speaker System Board-without processor or memory Card Guide Fan Assembly, front, 120x25 mm C2 Switch Assembly 13.5 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive 15.0 GB EIDE Hard Disk Drive Order either of the below 9.1 GB SCSI 7.2K RPM hard drives 9.1 GB LVD SCSI Hard Disk Drive, 7.2K RPM 9.1 GB LVD SCSI Hard Disk Drive, 7.2K RPM Order either of the below 9.1 GB SCSI 10K RPM hard drives 9.1 GB LVD SCSI Hard Disk Drive, 10K RPM 9.1 GB LVD SCSI Hard Disk Drive, 10K RPM Order either of the below 18.2 GB SCSI 7.2K RPM hard drives 18.2 GB LVD SCSI Hard Disk Drive, 7.2K RPM 18.2 GB LVD SCSI Hard Disk Drive, 7.2K RPM Removable Rail Access Cover Assembly SCSI Adapter - Adaptec 2940 LVD Video Adapter - Appian Gemini Appian Gemini video Cable Video Adapter - Canopus DVRaptor (model 91X, 92X) Canopus DVRaptor cable assembly (model 91X, 92X) Video Adapter - Elsa GL II (AGP) Video Adapter - Intergraph Intense 3D PRO 4110 (AGP) Video Adapter - Matrox G400-REV E (AGP) Video Adapter - IBM Fire GL1 (AGP) Air Baffle Fan Assembly, rear, 120x38 mm FRU No. 12J5547 02K1414 01K1637 09N0737 75H9550 75H9552 01K1888 12J5551 12J5549 12J5552 03K9654 10L5596 01N2032 01N2386 10L5592 37L2355 10L5595 37L5719 09N0921
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 16
16 16
36L8648 36L8763
16 16
36L8767 36L8771
16 16 17 18 19 19 19
36L8649 36L8765 37L2358 12J5546 00N3269 09N0360 01N2333 01N2264 01N2377 01N2256 37L2406 01N2197 37L2375 00N3649 10L5593
19 19 19 19 20 21
404
Index 22 23 23 23 23 24 25 25 25 25 25 25 26 27 28
System (Type 6868/6878) 3.5-In. Hard Disk Bracket 64 MB PC 600 ECC RAMBUS RIMM Memory 128 MB PC600 ECC RAMBUS RIMM Memory 256 MB PC600 ECC RAMBUS RIMM Memory Memory Continuity card (C-RIMM) Terminator Card Terminator Card Housing 600 MHz Pentium III microprocessor 667 MHz Pentium III microprocessor 733 MHz Pentium III microprocessor 800 MHz Pentium III microprocessor 866 MHz Pentium III microprocessor 933 MHz Pentium III microprocessor Processor Retainer Kit Power Supply 330 W. Keylock Assembly Chassis Assembly, with support bracket Cable - Audio CD-ROM Cable - CD-ROM, IDE Cable - Diskette Drive Cable - Hard Disk, ATA 2-drop Cable - LVD SCSI 5-drop Cable - SCSI LED EMC Kit Foot (Qty 4) Hard Disk Screw Kit Hard Disk Tray, 5.14-inch to 3.5-inch Lithium Battery Type 2032 Lithium Battery Type 2450 Miscellaneous Hardware Kit Mouse, 3 button Picture frame bezel kit
FRU No. 10L5591 33L3094 33L3096 33L3098 00N5223 37L5949 10L6936 37L6034 00N3622 00N7174 09N9097 09N4877 09K9598 33L4321 36L8849 12J5102 37L2354 75H9219 01K1548 01K1546 33L2564 01K1549 76H7344 37L2352 12J4506 01N2199 28L5045 33F8354 04G5389 10L5600 28L1868 00N5245
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
405
406
Display and Monitor Information Display and monitor information is separately available and is listed under Related publications on page v.
Special tools
The following tools are required to service these computers: A volt-ohm meter, IBM P/N 73G5404 Wrap Plug, IBM P/N 72X8546
IntelliStation - 6868/6878
407
408
409
410
DANGER To avoid a shock hazard, do not connect or disconnect any cables or perform installation, maintenance, or reconfiguration of this product during an electrical storm.
To avoid shock hazard: The power cord must be connected to a properly wired and earthed receptacle. Any equipment to which this product will be attached must also be connected to properly wired receptacles.
When possible, use one hand to connect or disconnect signal cables to prevent a possible shock from touching two surfaces with different electrical potentials.
Electrical current from power, telephone, and communications cables is hazardous. To avoid shock hazard, connect and disconnect cables as described following when installing, moving, or opening covers of this product or attached devices.
To Connect 1. Turn Everything OFF. 2. First, attach all cables to devices. 3. Attach signal cables to receptacles. 4. Attach power cord(s) to outlet. 5. Turn device ON.
To Disconnect 1. Turn Everything OFF. 2. First, remove power cord(s) from outlet. 3. Remove signal cables from receptacles. 4. Remove all cables from devices.
NOTE: In the UK, by law, the telephone cable must be connected after the power cord.
NOTE: In the UK, the power cord must be disconnected after the telephone cable.
411
Caution: When replacing the battery, use only Lithium Battery Type 2032 (IBM Part Number 33F8354), Lithium Battery Type 2450 (IBM Part Number 04G5389), or an equivalent type battery recommended by the manufacturer. If your system has a module containing a lithium battery, replace it only with the same module type made by the same manufacturer. The battery contains lithium and can explode if not properly used, handled, or disposed of. Do not: Throw or immerse into water Heat to more than 100C (212F) Repair or disassemble Dispose of the battery as required by local ordinances or regulations.
Caution: When a CD-ROM drive is installed, note the following. Use of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures other than those specified herein might result in hazardous radiation exposure. Removing the covers of the CD-ROM drive could result in exposure to hazardous laser radiation. There are no serviceable parts inside the CD-ROM drive. Do not remove the CD-ROM drive covers.
DANGER Some CD-ROM drives contain an embedded Class 3A or Class 3B laser diode. Note the following. Laser radiation when open. Do not stare into the beam, do not view directly with optical instruments, and avoid direct exposure to the beam.
412
32 kg (70.5 lbs)
55 kg (121.2 lbs)
Caution: Electrical current from power, telephone, and communication cables can be hazardous. To avoid personal injury or equipment damage, disconnect the attached power cords, telecommunications systems, networks, and modems before you open the server covers, unless instructed otherwise in the installation and configuration procedures.
413
PERIGO Para evitar choques eltricos, no conecte ou desconecte nenhum cabo, nem efetue instalao, manuteno ou reconfigurao deste produto durante uma tempestade com raios.
Para evitar choques eltricos: O cabo de alimentao deve ser conectado a um receptculo corretamente instalado e aterrado. Todos os equipamentos aos quais este produto ser conectado devem tambm ser conectados a receptculos corretamente instalados.
Quando possvel, utilize uma das mos para conectar ou desconectar cabos de sinal, para evitar um possvel choque ao tocar duas superfcies com potenciais eltricos diferentes.
A corrente eltrica proveniente de cabos de alimentao, de telefone e de comunicao perigosa. Para evitar choques eltricos, conecte e desconecte os cabos conforme descrito a seguir, ao instalar, movimentar ou abrir tampas deste produto ou de dispositivos conectados.
Para Conectar 1. DESLIGUE tudo. 2. Conecte primeiro todos os cabos nos dispositivos. 3. Conecte os cabos de sinal nos receptculos. 4. Conecte o(s) cabo(s) de alimentao nas tomadas. 5. LIGUE o dispositivo.
Para Desconectar 1. DESLIGUE tudo. 2. Remova primeiro o(s) cabo(s) de alimentao das tomadas. 3. Remova os cabos de sinal dos receptculos. 4. Remova todos os cabos dos dispositivos.
414
cuidado: Ao substituir a bateria, utilize apenas o Nmero de Pea IBM 33F8354 ou um tipo de bateria equivalente recomendado pelo fabricante. Se seu sistema possuir um mdulo com uma bateria de ltio, substitua-o apenas pelo mesmo tipo de mdulo, produzido pelo mesmo fabricante. A bateria contm ltio e pode explodir se no for utilizada, manuseada e descartada de forma adequada. No: Jogue ou coloque na gua Aquea a mais de 100C (212F) Conserte nem desmonte. Descarte a bateria conforme requerido pelas disposies e regulamentaes locais.
cuidado: Quando uma unidade de CD-ROM estiver instalada, observe o seguinte. A utilizao de controles ou ajustes ou a execuo de procedimentos diferentes daqueles especificados nesta publicao pode resultar em exposio perigosa radiao. A remoo das tampas da unidade de CD-ROM pode resultar em exposio a radiao perigosa de laser. No existem peas que possam ser consertadas no interior da unidade de CD-ROM. No remova as tampas da unidade de CD-ROM.
PERIGO Algumas unidades de CD-ROM contm um diodo de laser da Classe 3A ou da Classe 3B. Observe o seguinte. Radiao de laser quando aberto. No olhe diretamente para o feixe de laser, no olhe diretamente com instrumentos ticos, e evite exposio direta ao raio.
415
32 kg (70,5 lbs)
55 kg (121,2 lbs)
cuidado: Utilize prticas seguras para levantamento de peso ao levantar sua mquina.
cuidado: A corrente eltrica proveniente de cabos de alimentao, de telefone e de comunicao perigosa. Para evitar ferimentos pessoais ou danos aos equipamentos, desconecte os cabos de alimentao, sistemas de telecomunicao, redes e modems antes de abrir as tampas do servidor, a menos que receba outras instrues nos procedimentos de instalao e configurao.
416
417
418
419
PERIGO Pour viter tout risque de choc lectrique, ne manipulez aucun cble et n'effectuez aucune opration d'installation, d'entretien ou de reconfiguration de ce produit au cours d'un orage. Pour viter tout risque de choc lectrique : Les cordons d'alimentation du prsent produit et de tous les appareils qui lui sont connects doivent tre branchs sur des socles de prise de courant correctement cbls et mis la terre. Afin d'viter tout risque de choc lectrique provenant d'une diffrence de potentiel de terre, n'utilisez qu'une main, lorsque cela est possible, pour connecter ou dconnecter les cordons d'interface. Le courant lectrique passant dans les cbles de communication, ou les cordons tlphoniques et d'alimentation peut tre dangereux. Pour viter tout risque de choc lectrique, lorsque vous installez ou que vous dplacez le prsent produit ou des priphriques qui lui sont raccords, reportez-vous aux instructions ci-dessous pour connecter et dconnecter les diffrents cordons.
Connexion 1. Mettez les units hors tension. 2. Commencez par brancher tous les cordons sur les units. 3. Branchez les cbles d'interface sur les prises. 4. Branchez les cordons d'alimentation sur un socle de prise de courant. 5. Mettez les units sous tension.
Dconnexion 1. Mettez les units hors tension. 2. Commencez pas dbrancher les cordons alimentation des socles de prise de courant. 3. Dbranchez les cbles d'interface des prises. 4. Dbranchez tous les cbles des units.
420
attention: Remplacez la pile usage par une pile de rfrence identique exclusivement - voir la rfrence IBM - ou par une pile quivalente recommande par le fabricant. Si votre systme est dot d'un module contenant une pile au lithium, vous devez le remplacer uniquement par un module identique, produit par le mme fabricant. La pile contient du lithium et prsente donc un risque d'explosion en cas de mauvaise manipulation ou utilisation. Ne la jetez pas l'eau. Ne l'exposez pas une temprature suprieure 100 C. Ne cherchez pas la rparer ou la dmonter. Pour la mise au rebut, reportez-vous la rglementation en vigueur.
attention: Si une unit de CD-ROM est installe, prenez connaissance des informations suivantes : Pour viter tout risque d'exposition au rayon laser, respectez les consignes de rglage et d'utilisation des commandes, ainsi que les procdures dcrites dans le prsent document. Pour viter une exposition directe au rayon laser, n'ouvrez pas l'unit de CD-ROM. Vous ne pouvez effectuer aucune opration de maintenance l'intrieur.
PERIGO Certaines units de CD-ROM contiennent une diode laser de classe 3A ou 3B. Prenez connaissance des informations suivantes : Rayonnement laser lorsque le carter est ouvert. vitez de regarder fixement le faisceau ou de l'observer l'aide d'instruments optiques. vitez une exposition directe au rayon.
421
32 kg
55 kg
attention: Le courant lectrique circulant dans les cbles de communication et les cordons tlphoniques et d'alimentation peut tre dangereux. Pour votre scurit et celle de l'quipement, avant de retirer les carters du serveur, mettez celui-ci hors tension et dconnectez ses cordons d'alimentation, ainsi que les cbles qui le relient aux rseaux, aux systmes de tlcommunication et aux modems (sauf instruction contraire mentionne dans les procdures d'installation et de configuration).
422
VORSICHT Aus Sicherheitsgrnden bei Gewitter an diesem Gert keine Kabel anschlieen oder lsen. Ferner keine Installations-, Wartungsoder Rekonfigurationsarbeiten durchfhren.
Aus Sicherheitsgrnden: Gert nur an eine Schutzkontaktsteckdose mit ordnungsgem geerdetem Schutzkontakt anschlieen. Alle angeschlossenen Gerte ebenfalls an Schutzkontaktsteckdosen mit ordnungsgem geerdetem Schutzkontakt anschlieen.
Signalkabel mglichst einhndig anschlieen oder lsen, um einen Stromschlag durch Berhren von Oberflchen mit unterschiedlichem elektrischem Potential zu vermeiden.
Elektrische Spannungen von Netz-, Telefonund Datenbertragungsleitungen sind gefhrlich. Um einen Stromschlag zu vermeiden, nur nach den Anweisungen arbeiten, die fr Installation, Transport oder ffnen von Gehusen dieses Produkts oder angeschlossenen Einheiten gelten.
Kabel anschlieen 1. Alle Gerte ausschalten und Netzstecker ziehen. 2. Zuerst alle Kabel an Einheiten anschlieen. 3. Signalkabel an Anschlubuchsen anschlieen. 4. Netzstecker an Steckdose anschlieen. 5. Gert einschalten.
Kabel lsen 1. Alle Gerte ausschalten. 2. Zuerst Netzstecker von Steckdose lsen. 3. Signalkabel von Anschlubuchsen lsen. 4. Alle Kabel von Einheiten lsen.
423
achtung: Eine verbrauchte Batterie nur durch eine Batterie mit der IBM Teilenummer 33F8354 oder durch eine vom Hersteller empfohlene Batterie ersetzen. Wenn Ihr System ein Modul mit einer Lithium-Batterie enthlt, ersetzen Sie es immer mit dem selben Modultyp vom selben Hersteller. Die Batterie enthlt Lithium und kann bei unsachgemer Verwendung, Handhabung oder Entsorgung explodieren. Die Batterie nicht mit Wasser in Berhrung bringen. ber 100 C erhitzen. reparieren oder zerlegen. Die rtlichen Bestimmungen fr die Entsorgung von Sondermll beachten.
achtung: Wenn ein CD-ROM-Laufwerk installiert ist, beachten Sie folgendes. Steuer- und Einstellelemente sowie Verfahren nur entsprechend den Anweisungen im vorliegenden Handbuch einsetzen. Andernfalls kann gefhrliche Laserstrahlung auftreten. Das Entfernen der Abdeckungen des CD-ROM-Laufwerks kann zu gefhrlicher Laserstrahlung fhren. Es befinden sich keine Teile innerhalb des CD-ROM-Laufwerks, die vom Benutzer gewartet werden mssen. Die Verkleidung des CD-ROM-Laufwerks nicht ffnen.
VORSICHT Manche CD-ROM-Laufwerke enthalten eine eingebaute Laserdiode der Klasse 3A oder 3B. Die nachfolgend aufgefhrten Punkte beachten. Laserstrahlung bei geffneter Tr. Niemals direkt in den Laserstrahl sehen, nicht direkt mit optischen Instrumenten betrachten und den Strahlungsbereich meiden.
424
32 kg
55 kg
achtung: An Netz-, Telefon- und Datenleitungen knnen gefhrliche elektrische Spannungen anliegen. Um eine Gefhrdung des Benutzers oder Beschdigung des Gerts zu vermeiden, ist der Server auszuschalten. Die Verbindung zu den angeschlossenen Netzkabeln, Telekommunikationssystemen, Netzwerken und Modems ist vor dem ffnen des Servergehuses zu unterbrechen (sofern in Installations- und Konfigurationsanweisungen nicht anders angegeben).
425
PERICOLO Per evitare il pericolo di scosse elettriche durante i temporali, non collegare o scollegare cavi, non effettuare l'installazione, la manutenzione o la riconfigurazione di questo prodotto.
Per evitare il pericolo di scosse elettriche: collegare il cavo di alimentazione ad una presa elettrica correttamente cablata e munita di terra di sicurezza; collegare qualsiasi apparecchiatura collegata a questo prodotto ad una presa elettrica correttamente cablata e munita di terra di sicurezza.
Quando possibile, collegare o scollegare i cavi di segnale con una sola mano per evitare il rischio di scosse derivanti dal contatto con due superfici a diverso potenziale elettrico.
La corrente elettrica circolante nei cavi di alimentazione, del telefono e di segnale pericolosa. Per evitare scosse elettriche, collegare e scollegare i cavi come descritto quando si effettuano l'installazione, la rimozione o l'apertura dei coperchi di questo prodotto o durante il collegamento delle unit.
Per collegare 1. SPEGNERE tutti i dispositivi. 2. Collegare prima tutti i cavi alle unit. 3. Collegare i cavi di segnale alle prese. 4. Collegare il(i) cavo(i) di alimentazione alla presa elettrica. 5. ACCENDERE le unit.
Per scollegare 1. SPEGNERE tutti i dispositivi. 2. Rimuovere prima il(i) cavo(i) di alimentazione dalla presa elettrica. 3. Rimuovere i cavi di segnale dalle prese. 4. Rimuovere tutti i cavi dalle unit.
426
ATTENZIONE: Quando si sostituisce la batteria, utilizzare solo una batteria IBM o batterie dello stesso tipo o di tipo equivalente consigliate dal produttore. Se il sistema di cui si dispone provvisto di un modulo contenente una batteria al litio, sostituire tale batteria solo con un tipo di modulo uguale a quello fornito dal produttore. La batteria contiene litio e pu esplodere se utilizzata, maneggiata o smaltita impropriamente. Evitare di: Gettarla o immergerla in acqua Riscaldarla ad una temperatura superiore ai 100 C Cercare di ripararla o smaltirla Smaltire secondo la normativa in vigore (D.Lgs 22 del 5/2/97) e successive disposizioni nazionali e locali.
ATTENZIONE: Quando installata un'unit CD-ROM, notare quanto segue: L'utilizzo di controlli, regolazioni o l'esecuzione di procedure non descritti nel presente manuale possono provocare l'esposizione a radiazioni pericolose. L'apertura di un'unit CD-ROM pu determinare l'esposizione a radiazioni laser pericolose. All'interno dell'unit CD-ROM non vi sono parti su cui effettuare l'assistenza tecnica. Non rimuovere i coperchi dell'unit CD-ROM.
PERICOLO Alcune unit CD-ROM contengono all'interno un diodo laser di Classe 3A o Classe 3B. Prestare attenzione a quanto segue: Aprendo l'unit vengono emesse radiazioni laser. Non fissare il fascio, non guardarlo direttamente con strumenti ottici ed evitare l'esposizione diretta al fascio.
427
32 kg
55 kg
ATTENZIONE: La corrente circolante nei cavi di alimentazione, del telefono e di segnale pericolosa. Per evitare situazioni pericolose per le persone o danneggiamenti all'apparecchiatura, scollegare i cavi di alimentazione, i sistemi di telecomunicazioni, le reti e ed i modem prima di aprire i coperchi del servente se non diversamente indicato nelle procedure di installazione e configurazione.
428
429
430
PELIGRO Para evitar una posible descarga elctrica, no conecte ni desconecte los cables ni lleve a cabo ninguna operacin de instalacin, de mantenimiento o de reconfiguracin de este producto durante una tormenta elctrica. Para evitar una posible descarga: El cable de alimentacin debe conectarse a un receptculo con una instalacin elctrica correcta y con toma de tierra. Los aparatos a los que se conecte este producto tambin deben estar conectados a receptculos con la debida instalacin elctrica. Cuando sea posible, utilice una sola mano para conectar o desconectar los cables de seal a fin de evitar una posible descarga al tocar dos superficies con distinto potencial elctrico. La corriente elctrica de los cables de comunicaciones, telfono y alimentacin puede resultar peligrosa. Para evitar una posible descarga, siga las indicaciones de conexin y desconexin de los cables siempre que tenga que instalar, mover o abrir las cubiertas de este producto o de los dispositivos acoplados.
Instrucciones de conexin 1. Apague todos los componentes (OFF). 2. En primer lugar, conecte todos los cables a los dispositivos. 3. Conecte los cables de seal a los receptculos. 4. Conecte los cables de alimentacin a las tomas. 5. Encienda el dispositivo (ON).
Instrucciones de desconexin 1. Encienda todos los componentes (ON). 2. En primer lugar, retire los cables de alimentacin de las tomas. 3. Retire los cables de seal de los receptculos. 4. Retire todos los cables de los dispositivos.
431
percaucin: Al cambiar la batera, utilice nicamente la batera IBM Nmero de pieza 33F8354 o un tipo de batera equivalente recomendado por el fabricante. Si el sistema tiene un mdulo que contiene una batera de litio, sustityalo nicamente por el mismo tipo de mdulo del mismo fabricante. La batera contiene litio y puede explotar si no se utiliza, manipula o desecha correctamente. Lo que no debe hacer Tirar o sumergir el producto en agua. Exponer el producto a una temperatura superior a 100C. Reparar o desmontar el producto. Cuando quiera desechar la batera, siga las disposiciones y reglamentaciones locales.
percaucin: Cuando instale una unidad de CD-ROM, tenga en cuenta la siguiente informacin. Si se llevan a cabo controles o ajustes o se utilizan mtodos que no se atengan a lo aqu especificado, se puede producir una exposicin peligrosa a las radiaciones. Si se retiran las cubiertas de la unidad de CD-ROM, se puede producir una peligrosa exposicin a radiaciones de lser. Dentro de la unidad de CD-ROM no existen piezas reparables. No retire las cubiertas de la unidad de CD-ROM. PELIGRO Algunas unidades de CD-ROM tienen incorporado un diodo de lser de Clase 3A o de Clase 3B Tenga en cuenta la siguiente informacin. Cuando la unidad est abierta se generan emisiones de rayos lser. No dirija la mirada al haz, no lo observe directamente con instrumentos pticos y evite la exposicin directa.
432
32 kg
55 kg
percaucin: Alce la mquina con cuidado; el sobrepeso podra causar alguna lesin.
percaucin: La corriente elctrica de los cables de comunicaciones, de telfono y de alimentacin puede resultar peligrosa. Para evitar posibles lesiones o daos del aparato, desconecte los cables de alimentacin, los sistemas de telecomunicaciones, las redes y los mdems antes de abrir las cubiertas del servidor, salvo que se indique lo contrario en las instrucciones de las operaciones de instalacin y configuracin.
433
Safety information
The following section contains the safety information that you need to be familiar with before servicing an IBM mobile computer.
General safety
Follow these rules to ensure general safety: Observe good housekeeping in the area of the machines during and after maintenance. When lifting any heavy object: 1. Ensure you can stand safely without slipping. 2. Distribute the weight of the object equally between your feet. 3. Use a slow lifting force. Never move suddenly or twist when you attempt to lift. 4. Lift by standing or by pushing up with your leg muscles; this action removes the strain from the muscles in your back. Do not attempt to lift any objects that weigh more than 16 kg (35 lb) or objects that you think are too heavy for you. Do not perform any action that causes hazards to the customer, or that makes the equipment unsafe. Before you start the machine, ensure that other service representatives and the customer's personnel are not in a hazardous position. Place removed covers and other parts in a safe place, away from all personnel, while you are servicing the machine. Keep your tool case away from walk areas so that other people will not trip over it. Do not wear loose clothing that can be trapped in the moving parts of a machine. Ensure that your sleeves are fastened or rolled up above your elbows. If your hair is long, fasten it. Insert the ends of your necktie or scarf inside clothing or fasten it with a nonconductive clip, approximately 8 centimeters (3 inches) from the end. Do not wear jewelry, chains, metal-frame eyeglasses, or metal fasteners for your clothing. Remember: Metal objects are good electrical conductors. Wear safety glasses when you are: hammering, drilling soldering, cutting wire, attaching springs, using solvents, or working in any other conditions that might be hazardous to your eyes. After service, reinstall all safety shields, guards, labels, and ground wires. Replace any safety device that is worn or defective. Reinstall all covers correctly before returning the machine to the customer.
434
Electrical safety
Observe the following rules when working on electrical equipment. Important Use only approved tools and test equipment. Some hand tools have handles covered with a soft material that does not insulate you when working with live electrical currents. Many customers have, near their equipment, rubber floor mats that contain small conductive fibers to decrease electrostatic discharges. Do not use this type of mat to protect yourself from electrical shock. Find the room emergency power-off (EPO) switch, disconnecting switch, or electrical outlet. If an electrical accident occurs, you can then operate the switch or unplug the power cord quickly. Do not work alone under hazardous conditions or near equipment that has hazardous voltages. Disconnect all power before: Performing a mechanical inspection Working near power supplies Removing or installing main units Before you start to work on the machine, unplug the power cord. If you cannot unplug it, ask the customer to power-off the wall box that supplies power to the machine and to lock the wall box in the off position. If you need to work on a machine that has exposed electrical circuits, observe the following precautions: Ensure that another person, familiar with the power-off controls, is near you. Remember: Another person must be there to switch off the power, if necessary. Use only one hand when working with powered-on electrical equipment; keep the other hand in your pocket or behind your back. Remember: There must be a complete circuit to cause electrical shock. By observing the above rule, you may prevent a current from passing through your body. When using testers, set the controls correctly and use the approved probe leads and accessories for that tester. Stand on suitable rubber mats (obtained locally, if necessary) to insulate you from grounds such as metal floor strips and machine frames.
Observe the special safety precautions when you work with very high voltages; these instructions are in the safety sections of maintenance information. Use extreme care when measuring high voltages. Related Service Information
435
Regularly inspect and maintain your electrical hand tools for safe operational condition. Do not use worn or broken tools and testers. Never assume that power has been disconnected from a circuit. First, check that it has been powered-off. Always look carefully for possible hazards in your work area. Examples of these hazards are moist floors, nongrounded power extension cables, power surges, and missing safety grounds. Do not touch live electrical circuits with the reflective surface of a plastic dental mirror. The surface is conductive; such touching can cause personal injury and machine damage. Do not service the following parts with the power on when they are removed from their normal operating places in a machine: Power supply units Pumps Blowers and fans Motor generators and similar units. (This practice ensures correct grounding of the units.) If an electrical accident occurs: Use caution; do not become a victim yourself. Switch off power. Send another person to get medical aid. Asset ID allows the computer to be scanned by various radio frequency emitting devices supplied by independent companies. Asset ID is intended for use only with radio frequency equipment that meets ANSI/IEEE C95.1 1992 RF Radiation Limits.
436
Explosive hazards, such as a damaged CRT face or bulging capacitor Mechanical hazards, such as loose or missing hardware The guide consists of a series of steps presented in a checklist. Begin the checks with the power off, and the power cord disconnected. Checklist: 1. Check exterior covers for damage (loose, broken, or sharp edges). 2. Power-off the computer. Disconnect the power cord. 3. Check the power cord for: a. A third-wire ground connector in good condition. Use a meter to measure third-wire ground continuity for 0.1 ohm or less between the external ground pin and frame ground. b. The power cord should be the appropriate type as specified in the parts listings. c. Insulation must not be frayed or worn. 4. Remove the cover. 5. Check for any obvious non-IBM alterations. Use good judgment as to the safety of any non-IBM alterations. 6. Check inside the unit for any obvious unsafe conditions, such as metal filings, contamination, water or other liquids, or signs of fire or smoke damage. 7. Check for worn, frayed, or pinched cables. 8. Check that the power-supply cover fasteners (screws or rivets) have not been removed or tampered with.
437
Grounding requirements
Electrical grounding of the computer is required for operator safety and correct system function. Proper grounding of the electrical outlet can be verified by a certified electrician.
438
Miscellaneous information
Acronyms, Abbreviations and Terms
Term ACPA/A ADP AGP Alt ANSI ARTIC ASCII AT AVC BIOS bps BPS CCITT CCS CCSB CCSB CD CDPD CD-ROM CGA CRC CRT CSA CSD DASD DMA DRAM ECA ECC EGA ESD ESDI EEPROM EWS FRU GPIB GSA Ht IDE IC IEEE IEC IML IPL ISA ISO ISDN LAN LBA LTB LUN MAP Information Audio Capture and Playback Adapter Automatic Data Processing Advanced Graphics Port Alternate American National Standards Institute A Real Time Interface Coprocessor American National Standard Code for Interface Interchange Advanced Technology (as in AT Bus) Audio Video Connection Basic Input/Output System (Controls System Resources) Bits Per Second Bytes Per Second The International Telephone and Telegraph Consultative Committee Common Command Set Common Complete Status Block Configuration Control Sub Board Compact Disc Cellular Digital Packet Data CD Read Only Memory (stores data/audio) Color Graphics Adapter (See EGA, VGA, XGA) Cyclic Redundancy Check Cathode Ray Tube Canadian Standards Association Corrective Service Diskette Direct Access Storage Device (hard disk, diskette) Direct Memory Access Dynamic Random Access Memory Engineering Change Announcement Error Correction Code Enhanced Graphics Adapter Electrostatic Discharge Enhanced Small Device Interface Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory Energy Work Station Field Replaceable Unit (replaceable part) General Purpose Interface Bus (IEEE 348) General Services Administration Height Integrated Drive Electronics Integrated Circuit Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers International Electrotechnical Commission Initial Machine Load Initial Program Load Industry Standard Architecture International Organization for Standardization Integrated-Services Digital Network Local Area Network Local Block Address Local Transfer Bus Logical Unit Number (as in SCSI) Maintenance Analysis Procedure
439
Term MCGA MCA MHz MIDI MM N/A NDD NDIS NMI NSC NVRAM OEM PCI PCMCIA POS PUN RAID RAM RGB RIPL ROM SASD SCB SCSI SCSI ID SPD SR SRAM SVGA STN T/A TDD TFT TPF TSR UL VCA VESA VGA VPD VRAM WORM XGA Y/C
Information Modified Color Graphics Adapter (320 x 200 x 256) Micro Channel Architecture (bus structure) Mega Hertz (million cycles per second) Musical Instrument Digital Interface Multimedia Not Available or Not Applicable National Distribution Division Network Driver Interface Specification Non-Maskable Interrupt National Support Center Non Volatile Random Access Memory Original Equipment Manufacturer Peripheral component interconnect Personal Computer Memory Card International Association Programmable Option Select Physical Unit Number (as in SCSI) Redundant Array of Inexpensive Disks (disk array models) Random Access Memory (read/write) Red Green Blue (as in monitors) Remote Initial Program Load Read Only Memory Sequential Access Storage Device (Tape) Subsystem Control Block Small Computer Systems Interface SCSI Identification Number (assigned device number) Software Product Description Service Representative Static Random Access Memory Super Video Graphics Array Super Twisted Nematic NDD Technical Advisor (See your Marketing Representative) Telecommunications Device for the Deaf Thin-Film Transistor ThinkPad File Terminate and Stay Resident Underwriters Laboratory Video Capture Adapter Video Electronics Standards Association Video Graphics Array (640x480x16) Vital Product Data Video Random Access Memory Write Once, Read Many Media Extended Graphics Array (1024 x 768 x 256) Luminance/Chrominance Signal (Video)
440
Name
2. What would you like to see added, changed, or deleted in this manual?
3. What is your service experience level? _____ Less than five years _____ More than five years
441
442
443
File updates
Use the World Wide Web (WWW) to download Diagnostic, BIOS Flash, and Device Driver files. For PC Series 300/700 and IntelliStation systems, the WWW address is: http://www.pc.ibm.com/us/files.html For IBM PC Servers, the WWW address is: http://www.pc.ibm.com/us/servers/
Hardware considerations
Use the following tools to help identify and resolve hardware-related problems: Power-on self-test (POST) POST Beep codes Test programs Error messages POST does the following: Checks some basic system board operations Checks the memory operation Starts the video operation Verifies that the diskette drive is working Verifies that the hard disk drive is working Use the test programs that come with this HMM or with the system you are servicing to test the IBM components of the system and some external devices. Also, from the DOS command or from OS/2 Utilities, use the CHKDSK command to check and repair hard disk data allocation errors. Error messages generated by the software, (the operating system or application programs), generally are text messages, however, error messages can be text, numeric, or both text and numeric. Any time there is an error message indicating a problem with the system, follow the General Checkout procedures in this HMM to resolve the problem. Basically, there are five types of error messages: POST error messages are displayed when the POST finds problems with the hardware or detects a change in the hardware configuration. POST Beep codes are sounds emitted from the speaker if the POST finds a problem. One beep indicates the POST completed successfully. Multiple beeps indicate a problem was found. Diagnostic error messages are displayed when a test program finds a problem with a hardware component.
444
Software-generated error messages are displayed if a problem or conflict is found by an application program, the operating system, or both. For an explanation of these messages, refer to the information supplied with the installed software package. Also, refer to Software considerations. Multiple messages occur when the first error causes additional errors. Follow the suggested action of the first error displayed.
Software considerations
Suspect a software failure if: Hardware diagnostics run error-free. Swapping hardware components fails to isolate the problem. A software problem might be the result of a mismatch between the hardware and the operating system device drivers or direct drivers.
BIOS:
The BIOS acts as an interface between the system hardware, application software, and the operating system. BIOS contains the instructions to operate the basic system components: Keyboard Serial and parallel ports Diskette drive Hard disk drive VGA display Clock Memory controller The BIOS then starts the IPL or Boot functions.
Drivers: Device drivers are the BIOS for additional hardware. Device drivers are the communicators of the hardware assignments to the operating system, including:
IRQ level DMA channel I/O address ROM or RAM Some device drivers like HIMEM.SYS are position sensitive and must be placed before other device drivers in the CONFIG.SYS file. All device drivers are not found in the CONFIG.SYS file. Advanced operating systems use .INI files to setup and start devices. Device drivers can access the hardware five ways. Operating system direct to hardware using a direct driver. Direct drivers, which bypass BIOS, Related Service Information
445
have the advantage of faster throughput, but the disadvantage of limited error-handling capability and reduced software and hardware compatibility and flexibility. This method is not used in the IBM PC Series systems. Operating system to BIOS to hardware. This is the recommended way. It's the most flexible because it's independent of the hardware. Applications to operating system to BIOS to hardware. This method is inflexible and operating system dependent. Applications to BIOS to hardware. This method has some flexibility but it is BIOS dependent. Applications to hardware. This method is hardware dependent and very inflexible, however, it is very fast, very efficient, and it has no overhead.
446
IRQ conflicts occur when there are multiple assignments to the same interrupt level. If there is an IRQ conflict, the system will hang. Use the systems diagnostics to check for multiple assignments to the same interrupt level before replacing any hardware component. DMA: Accesses the memory by bypassing the processor, which allows the processor more time for applications and programs. Accesses memory directly from the serial and parallel ports on some systems. Accesses memory directly from some adapters using a DMA channel, which allows the adapter to operate faster. Provides from 4 to 15 DMA channels, the number varies depending on the system. If multiple assignments of the same DMA channel occur, the system will hang. Use the system diagnostics to check for multiple assignments to the same DMA channel before replacing any hardware components. I/O Address: A unique I/O address is assigned to each system component. If multiple assignments of the same I/O address occur, the system will hang. Use the DOS MEM command to check for multiple assignments to the same I/O address before replacing any hardware component. ROM and RAM Addresses: Adapter cards with processors can contain RAM and ROM. If the adapter cards have onboard memory, the: ROM contains operating instructions for the adapter I/O. RAM is used for buffering. Two adapters using the same memory area will cause a failure. This failure might appear as a hardware failure. The IRQ levels, DMA channels, I/O address, and ROM and RAM addresses all become potential conflicts and system problems. When conflicts arise, they might show up as system hangs, lost or missing devices, incorrect or bad data, or failing diagnostics. Always eliminate conflicts in these areas before replacing any hardware components.
447
800-551-2832
Note Calls from outside the U.S. will be charged international call rates.
448
800-661-2131 800-268-3100 800-387-8343 800-487-7426 800-663-7662 800-IBM-9990 800-263-2769 416-443-5808 (Fax) 416-443-5755 514-938-3022 905-316-4255 604-664-6464 204-934-2735 800-661-7768 800-565-3344 800-387-8483 800-465-1234 905-316-4148 905-316-4100 (Fax) 905-316-4150 905-316-4100 (Fax) 905-316-4872 905-316-4100 (Fax) 800-661-2131 800-565-3344 416-443-5835 (Fax) 905-316-2445 905-316-3515 (Fax) 416-443-5778 800-505-1855 800-267-7472
449
Notices
References in this publication to IBM products, programs, or services do not imply that IBM intends to make these available in all countries in which IBM operates. Any reference to an IBM product, program, or service is not intended to state or imply that only that IBM product, program, or service may be used. Subject to IBMs valid intellectual property or other legally protectable rights, any functionally equivalent product, program, or service may be used instead of the IBM product, program, or service. The evaluation and verification of operation in conjunction with other products, except those expressly designated by IBM, are the responsibility of the user. IBM may have patents or pending patent applications covering subject matter in this document. The furnishing of this document does not give you any license to these patents. You can send license inquiries, in writing, to: IBM Director of Licensing IBM Corporation North Castle Drive Armonk, NY 10504-1785 U.S.A.
450
Trademarks
The following terms are trademarks of the International Business Machines Corporation in the United States and/or other countries:
Aptiva BookManager FaxConcentrator HelpFax IntelliStation OS/2 Personal System/2 PS/2 SelectaSystem SystemXtra TrackPoint II Asset ID Business Partner HelpCenter HelpWare Micro Channel PC 300 Portmaster PS/ValuePoint Skill Dynamics ThinkPad Wake on LAN AT EduQuest HelpClub IBM NetView PC 700 PS/1 Rapid Resume SystemView TrackPoint XGA
ActionMedia, Celeron, LANDesk, MMX, Pentium, and ProShare are trademarks or registered trademarks of Intel Corporation in the U.S. and other countries. Microsoft, Windows, Windows NT, and the Windows logo are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. Other company, product, and service names used in this publication may be trademarks or service marks of others.
451
452
IBM
Part Number: 09N8610 Printed in U.S.A.
N-4 19- 2